blob: e801a1bf8a9accd095256d867814ca6cf4c03296 [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
2 HAProxy
3 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau21475e32010-05-23 08:46:08 +02005 version 1.5
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreau16216822012-09-10 09:46:55 +02007 2012/09/10
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
11specified above. It does not provide any hint, example or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013The summary below is meant to help you search sections by name and navigate
14through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
22 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to help get the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when it can become ambiguous. If you add sections,
25 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
341.2.1. The Request line
351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
371.3.1. The Response line
381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
422.2. Time format
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200432.3. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020044
453. Global parameters
463.1. Process management and security
473.2. Performance tuning
483.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100493.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200503.5. Peers
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020051
524. Proxies
534.1. Proxy keywords matrix
544.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
55
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200565. Bind and Server options
575.1. Bind options
585.2. Server and default-server options
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020059
606. HTTP header manipulation
61
Cyril Bonté7d38afb2010-02-03 20:41:26 +0100627. Using ACLs and pattern extraction
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200637.1. Matching integers
647.2. Matching strings
657.3. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +0200667.4. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200677.5. Available matching criteria
687.5.1. Matching at Layer 4 and below
697.5.2. Matching contents at Layer 4
707.5.3. Matching at Layer 7
717.6. Pre-defined ACLs
727.7. Using ACLs to form conditions
Cyril Bonté7d38afb2010-02-03 20:41:26 +0100737.8. Pattern extraction
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020074
758. Logging
768.1. Log levels
778.2. Log formats
788.2.1. Default log format
798.2.2. TCP log format
808.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +0100818.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200828.3. Advanced logging options
838.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
848.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
858.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
868.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
878.4. Timing events
888.5. Session state at disconnection
898.6. Non-printable characters
908.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
918.8. Capturing HTTP headers
928.9. Examples of logs
93
949. Statistics and monitoring
959.1. CSV format
969.2. Unix Socket commands
97
98
991. Quick reminder about HTTP
100----------------------------
101
102When haproxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
103fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
104on almost anything found in the contents.
105
106However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
107formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
108correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
109
110
1111.1. The HTTP transaction model
112-------------------------------
113
114The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100115to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200116from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client on the
117connection, the server responds and the connection is closed. A new request
118will involve a new connection :
119
120 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
121
122In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
123establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
124by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
125length.
126
127Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
128to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
129however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
130response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
131header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
132
133 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
134
135Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
136power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
137but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200138a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200139
140A last improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
141keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
142second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
143page :
144
145 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
146
147This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
148latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
149correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
150the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100151server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200152
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200153By default HAProxy operates in a tunnel-like mode with regards to persistent
154connections: for each connection it processes the first request and forwards
155everything else (including additional requests) to selected server. Once
156established, the connection is persisted both on the client and server
157sides. Use "option http-server-close" to preserve client persistent connections
158while handling every incoming request individually, dispatching them one after
159another to servers, in HTTP close mode. Use "option httpclose" to switch both
160sides to HTTP close mode. "option forceclose" and "option
161http-pretend-keepalive" help working around servers misbehaving in HTTP close
162mode.
163
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200164
1651.2. HTTP request
166-----------------
167
168First, let's consider this HTTP request :
169
170 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100171 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200172 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
173 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
174 3 User-agent: my small browser
175 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
176 5 Accept: image/png
177
178
1791.2.1. The Request line
180-----------------------
181
182Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
183
184 - a METHOD : GET
185 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
186 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
187
188All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
189which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
190followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
191is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
192desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
193the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
194
195The URI itself can have several forms :
196
197 - A "relative URI" :
198
199 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
200
201 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
202 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
203
204 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
205
206 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
207
208 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
209 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
210 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
211 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
212 must accept this form too.
213
214 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
215 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
216 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100217
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200218 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
219 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
220 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
221 other protocols too.
222
223In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
224mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
225on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
226It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
227specific to the language, framework or application in use.
228
229
2301.2.2. The request headers
231--------------------------
232
233The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
234beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
235an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
236Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
237values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
238encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
239the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
240define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
241
242Contrary to a common mis-conception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
243their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
244"Connection:" header).
245
246The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
247that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
248is one valid form of empty line.
249
250Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
251headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
252about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
253application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
254
255Important note:
256 As suggested by RFC2616, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
257 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
258 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
259 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
260
261
2621.3. HTTP response
263------------------
264
265An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
266messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
267
268 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100269 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200270 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
271 2 Content-length: 350
272 3 Content-Type: text/html
273
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200274As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
275codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
276response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100277continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
278the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
279following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
280sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
281(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
282correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
283such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
284state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
285over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
286if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
287information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200288
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200289
2901.3.1. The Response line
291------------------------
292
293Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
294
295 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
296 - a status code : 200
297 - a reason : OK
298
299The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200300 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (eg: 100, 101)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200301 - 2xx = OK, content is following (eg: 200, 206)
302 - 3xx = OK, no content following (eg: 302, 304)
303 - 4xx = error caused by the client (eg: 401, 403, 404)
304 - 5xx = error caused by the server (eg: 500, 502, 503)
305
306Please refer to RFC2616 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100307"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200308found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
309messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
310or "Authentication Required".
311
312Haproxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
313
314 Code When / reason
315 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
316 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
317 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
318 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
319 400 for an invalid or too large request
320 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
321 accessing the stats page)
322 403 when a request is forbidden by a "block" ACL or "reqdeny" filter
323 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
324 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
325 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
326 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
327 when an "rspdeny" filter blocks the response.
328 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
329 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
330 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
331
332The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3334.2).
334
335
3361.3.2. The response headers
337---------------------------
338
339Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
340the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
341details.
342
343
3442. Configuring HAProxy
345----------------------
346
3472.1. Configuration file format
348------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200349
350HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
351
352 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
353 - the "global" section, which sets process-wide parameters
354 - the proxies sections which can take form of "defaults", "listen",
355 "frontend" and "backend".
356
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100357The configuration file syntax consists in lines beginning with a keyword
358referenced in this manual, optionally followed by one or several parameters
359delimited by spaces. If spaces have to be entered in strings, then they must be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100360preceded by a backslash ('\') to be escaped. Backslashes also have to be
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100361escaped by doubling them.
362
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200363
3642.2. Time format
365----------------
366
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100367Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100368values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
369otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
370numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
371for every keyword. Supported units are :
372
373 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
374 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
375 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
376 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
377 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
378 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
379
380
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +02003812.3. Examples
382-------------
383
384 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
385 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
386 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
387 global
388 daemon
389 maxconn 256
390
391 defaults
392 mode http
393 timeout connect 5000ms
394 timeout client 50000ms
395 timeout server 50000ms
396
397 frontend http-in
398 bind *:80
399 default_backend servers
400
401 backend servers
402 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
403
404
405 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
406 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
407 global
408 daemon
409 maxconn 256
410
411 defaults
412 mode http
413 timeout connect 5000ms
414 timeout client 50000ms
415 timeout server 50000ms
416
417 listen http-in
418 bind *:80
419 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
420
421
422Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
423
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100424 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200425
426
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004273. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200428--------------------
429
430Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
431are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
432of them have command-line equivalents.
433
434The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
435
436 * Process management and security
437 - chroot
438 - daemon
439 - gid
440 - group
441 - log
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100442 - log-send-hostname
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200443 - nbproc
444 - pidfile
445 - uid
446 - ulimit-n
447 - user
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200448 - stats
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +0200449 - node
450 - description
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100451 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100452
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200453 * Performance tuning
454 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200455 - maxconnrate
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100456 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200457 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200458 - noepoll
459 - nokqueue
460 - nopoll
461 - nosepoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100462 - nosplice
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200463 - spread-checks
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200464 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200465 - tune.chksize
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200466 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100467 - tune.maxaccept
468 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200469 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200470 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100471 - tune.rcvbuf.client
472 - tune.rcvbuf.server
473 - tune.sndbuf.client
474 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100475
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200476 * Debugging
477 - debug
478 - quiet
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200479
480
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004813.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200482------------------------------------
483
484chroot <jail dir>
485 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
486 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
487 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
488 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
489 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
490 empty and unwritable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100491
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200492daemon
493 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
494 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
495 disabled by the command line "-db" argument.
496
497gid <number>
498 Changes the process' group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
499 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
500 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
501 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100502
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200503group <group name>
504 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
505 See also "gid" and "user".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100506
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200507log <address> <facility> [max level [min level]]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200508 Adds a global syslog server. Up to two global servers can be defined. They
509 will receive logs for startups and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100510 configured with "log global".
511
512 <address> can be one of:
513
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100514 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100515 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
516 port).
517
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +0100518 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
519 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
520 port).
521
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100522 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
523 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
524 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
525 writeable).
526
527 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200528
529 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
530 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
531 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
532
533 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200534 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
535 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
536 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
537 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
538 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
539 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200540
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200541 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200542
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100543log-send-hostname [<string>]
544 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
545 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
546 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
547 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
548 the logs.
549
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +0000550log-tag <string>
551 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
552 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
553 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
554 running on the same host.
555
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200556nbproc <number>
557 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
558 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
559 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
560 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
561 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. See also "daemon".
562
563pidfile <pidfile>
564 Writes pids of all daemons into file <pidfile>. This option is equivalent to
565 the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to the user
566 starting the process. See also "daemon".
567
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +0200568stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
569 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
570 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
571 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
572 consult section 9.2 "Unix Socket commands" for more details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +0200573
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +0200574 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
575 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
576 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200577
578stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
579 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
580 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +0100581 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200582
583stats maxconn <connections>
584 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
585 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
586
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200587uid <number>
588 Changes the process' user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
589 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
590 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
591 one. See also "gid" and "user".
592
593ulimit-n <number>
594 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
595 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
596 option.
597
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100598unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
599 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
600
601 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
602 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
603 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
604 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
605 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
606 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
607 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
608 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
609 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
610 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
611
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200612user <user name>
613 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
614 See also "uid" and "group".
615
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +0200616node <name>
617 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
618
619 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
620 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
621 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
622 traffic.
623
624description <text>
625 Add a text that describes the instance.
626
627 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
628 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
629 "<" and ">" characters.
630
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200631
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006323.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200633-----------------------
634
635maxconn <number>
636 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
637 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
638 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
639 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n".
640
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200641maxconnrate <number>
642 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
643 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
644 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
645 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
646 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
647 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
648 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
649 fairness.
650
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100651maxpipes <number>
652 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
653 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
654 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
655 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
656 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
657 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
658
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200659maxsslconn <number>
660 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
661 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
662 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
663 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
664 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
665 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
666 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
667
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200668noepoll
669 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
670 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
671 used will generally be "poll". See also "nosepoll", and "nopoll".
672
673nokqueue
674 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
675 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
676 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
677
678nopoll
679 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
680 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100681 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200682 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nosepoll", and "nopoll" and
683 "nokqueue".
684
685nosepoll
686 Disables the use of the "speculative epoll" event polling system on Linux. It
687 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-ds". The next polling system
688 used will generally be "epoll". See also "nosepoll", and "nopoll".
689
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100690nosplice
691 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
692 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
693 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100694 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100695 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
696 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
697 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
698 "option splice-response".
699
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200700spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
701 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending health checks to servers at exact
702 intervals, for instance when many logical servers are located on the same
703 physical server. With the help of this parameter, it becomes possible to add
704 some randomness in the check interval between 0 and +/- 50%. A value between
705 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The default value remains at 0.
706
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200707tune.bufsize <number>
708 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
709 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
710 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
711 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
712 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
713 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
714 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
715 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased.
716
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200717tune.chksize <number>
718 Sets the check buffer size to this size (in bytes). Higher values may help
719 find string or regex patterns in very large pages, though doing so may imply
720 more memory and CPU usage. The default value is 16384 and can be changed at
721 build time. It is not recommended to change this value, but to use better
722 checks whenever possible.
723
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200724tune.http.maxhdr <number>
725 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
726 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
727 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
728 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
729 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
730 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
731 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. Keep in mind that each
732 new header consumes 32bits of memory for each session, so don't push this
733 limit too high.
734
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100735tune.maxaccept <number>
736 Sets the maximum number of consecutive accepts that a process may perform on
737 a single wake up. High values give higher priority to high connection rates,
738 while lower values give higher priority to already established connections.
Willy Tarreauf49d1df2009-03-01 08:35:41 +0100739 This value is limited to 100 by default in single process mode. However, in
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100740 multi-process mode (nbproc > 1), it defaults to 8 so that when one process
741 wakes up, it does not take all incoming connections for itself and leaves a
Willy Tarreauf49d1df2009-03-01 08:35:41 +0100742 part of them to other processes. Setting this value to -1 completely disables
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100743 the limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak this value.
744
745tune.maxpollevents <number>
746 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
747 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
748 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
749 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
750 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
751
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200752tune.maxrewrite <number>
753 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
754 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
755 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
756 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
757 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
758 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
759 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
760 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
761 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
762 bufsize.
763
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200764tune.pipesize <number>
765 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
766 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
767 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
768 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
769 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
770 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
771
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100772tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
773tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
774 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
775 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
776 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
777 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
778 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
779 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
780 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
781
782tune.sndbuf.client <number>
783tune.sndbuf.server <number>
784 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
785 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
786 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
787 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
788 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
789 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
790 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
791 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
792 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
793 notifying haproxy again.
794
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200795
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007963.3. Debugging
797--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200798
799debug
800 Enables debug mode which dumps to stdout all exchanges, and disables forking
801 into background. It is the equivalent of the command-line argument "-d". It
802 should never be used in a production configuration since it may prevent full
803 system startup.
804
805quiet
806 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
807 line argument "-q".
808
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +0200809
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01008103.4. Userlists
811--------------
812It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
813http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
814it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
815
816userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100817 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100818 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
819
820group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100821 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100822 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
823 proceeded by "users" keyword.
824
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100825user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
826 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100827 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
828 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100829 evaluated using the crypt(3) function so depending of the system's
830 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example modern Glibc
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100831 based Linux system supports MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512 and of course classic,
832 DES-based method of crypting passwords.
833
834
835 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100836 userlist L1
837 group G1 users tiger,scott
838 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100839
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100840 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
841 user scott insecure-password elgato
842 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100843
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100844 userlist L2
845 group G1
846 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100847
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100848 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
849 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
850 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100851
852 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200853
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +0200854
8553.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200856----------
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +0200857It is possible to synchronize server entries in stick tables between several
858haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each instance
859pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. Server IDs are used to
860identify servers remotely, so it is important that configurations look similar
861or at least that the same IDs are forced on each server on all participants.
862Interrupted exchanges are automatically detected and recovered from the last
863known point. In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to
864the new one using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new
865process tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication
866during a reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large
867tables.
868
869peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -0400870 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +0200871 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
872
873peer <peername> <ip>:<port>
874 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
875 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
876 using "-L" command line option), haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer
877 connection on <ip>:<port>. Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to
878 to join the remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to
879 identify and validate the remote peer on the server side.
880
881 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
882 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
883
884 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
885 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument to change the local
886 peer name. This makes it easier to maintain coherent configuration files
887 across all peers.
888
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200889 Example:
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +0200890 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +0100891 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
892 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
893 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +0200894
895 backend mybackend
896 mode tcp
897 balance roundrobin
898 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
899 stick on src
900
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +0100901 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
902 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +0200903
904
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009054. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200906----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100907
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200908Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
909 - defaults <name>
910 - frontend <name>
911 - backend <name>
912 - listen <name>
913
914A "defaults" section sets default parameters for all other sections following
915its declaration. Those default parameters are reset by the next "defaults"
916section. See below for the list of parameters which can be set in a "defaults"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100917section. The name is optional but its use is encouraged for better readability.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200918
919A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
920connections.
921
922A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
923to forward incoming connections.
924
925A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
926parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
927
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100928All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
929'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
930case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
931
932Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
933logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
934proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
935However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
936name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
937
938Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
939and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100940bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100941protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
942modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
943arbitrary criteria.
944
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100945
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009464.1. Proxy keywords matrix
947--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100948
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200949The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
950limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
951they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
952limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +0100953marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, eg. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200954option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +0200955and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
956with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
957specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100958
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200959
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +0100960 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
961------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
962acl - X X X
963appsession - - X X
964backlog X X X -
965balance X - X X
966bind - X X -
967bind-process X X X X
968block - X X X
969capture cookie - X X -
970capture request header - X X -
971capture response header - X X -
972clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
973contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
974cookie X - X X
975default-server X - X X
976default_backend X X X -
977description - X X X
978disabled X X X X
979dispatch - - X X
980enabled X X X X
981errorfile X X X X
982errorloc X X X X
983errorloc302 X X X X
984-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
985errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +0200986force-persist - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +0100987fullconn X - X X
988grace X X X X
989hash-type X - X X
990http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +0100991http-check expect - - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +0200992http-check send-state X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +0100993http-request - X X X
994id - X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +0200995ignore-persist - X X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +0200996log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +0100997maxconn X X X -
998mode X X X X
999monitor fail - X X -
1000monitor-net X X X -
1001monitor-uri X X X -
1002option abortonclose (*) X - X X
1003option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
1004option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
1005option allbackups (*) X - X X
1006option checkcache (*) X - X X
1007option clitcpka (*) X X X -
1008option contstats (*) X X X -
1009option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
1010option dontlognull (*) X X X -
1011option forceclose (*) X X X X
1012-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1013option forwardfor X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02001014option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02001015option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001016option http-server-close (*) X X X X
1017option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
1018option httpchk X - X X
1019option httpclose (*) X X X X
1020option httplog X X X X
1021option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001022option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02001023option ldap-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001024option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
1025option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
1026option logasap (*) X X X -
1027option mysql-check X - X X
Rauf Kuliyev38b41562011-01-04 15:14:13 +01001028option pgsql-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001029option nolinger (*) X X X X
1030option originalto X X X X
1031option persist (*) X - X X
1032option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02001033option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001034option smtpchk X - X X
1035option socket-stats (*) X X X -
1036option splice-auto (*) X X X X
1037option splice-request (*) X X X X
1038option splice-response (*) X X X X
1039option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
1040option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
1041-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1042option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
1043option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
1044option tcpka X X X X
1045option tcplog X X X X
1046option transparent (*) X - X X
1047persist rdp-cookie X - X X
1048rate-limit sessions X X X -
1049redirect - X X X
1050redisp (deprecated) X - X X
1051redispatch (deprecated) X - X X
1052reqadd - X X X
1053reqallow - X X X
1054reqdel - X X X
1055reqdeny - X X X
1056reqiallow - X X X
1057reqidel - X X X
1058reqideny - X X X
1059reqipass - X X X
1060reqirep - X X X
1061reqisetbe - X X X
1062reqitarpit - X X X
1063reqpass - X X X
1064reqrep - X X X
1065-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1066reqsetbe - X X X
1067reqtarpit - X X X
1068retries X - X X
1069rspadd - X X X
1070rspdel - X X X
1071rspdeny - X X X
1072rspidel - X X X
1073rspideny - X X X
1074rspirep - X X X
1075rsprep - X X X
1076server - - X X
1077source X - X X
1078srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02001079stats admin - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001080stats auth X - X X
1081stats enable X - X X
1082stats hide-version X - X X
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02001083stats http-request - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001084stats realm X - X X
1085stats refresh X - X X
1086stats scope X - X X
1087stats show-desc X - X X
1088stats show-legends X - X X
1089stats show-node X - X X
1090stats uri X - X X
1091-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1092stick match - - X X
1093stick on - - X X
1094stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02001095stick store-response - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001096stick-table - - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02001097tcp-request connection - X X -
1098tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02001099tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02001100tcp-response content - - X X
1101tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001102timeout check X - X X
1103timeout client X X X -
1104timeout clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
1105timeout connect X - X X
1106timeout contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1107timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
1108timeout http-request X X X X
1109timeout queue X - X X
1110timeout server X - X X
1111timeout srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1112timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02001113timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001114transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01001115unique-id-format X X X -
1116unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001117use_backend - X X -
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02001118use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001119------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
1120 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001121
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001122
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011234.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
1124---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001125
1126This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
1127
1128
1129acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
1130 Declare or complete an access list.
1131 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1132 no | yes | yes | yes
1133 Example:
1134 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
1135 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
1136 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
1137
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001138 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001139
1140
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001141appsession <cookie> len <length> timeout <holdtime>
1142 [request-learn] [prefix] [mode <path-parameters|query-string>]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001143 Define session stickiness on an existing application cookie.
1144 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1145 no | no | yes | yes
1146 Arguments :
1147 <cookie> this is the name of the cookie used by the application and which
1148 HAProxy will have to learn for each new session.
1149
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001150 <length> this is the max number of characters that will be memorized and
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001151 checked in each cookie value.
1152
1153 <holdtime> this is the time after which the cookie will be removed from
1154 memory if unused. If no unit is specified, this time is in
1155 milliseconds.
1156
Cyril Bontébf47aeb2009-10-15 00:15:40 +02001157 request-learn
1158 If this option is specified, then haproxy will be able to learn
1159 the cookie found in the request in case the server does not
1160 specify any in response. This is typically what happens with
1161 PHPSESSID cookies, or when haproxy's session expires before
1162 the application's session and the correct server is selected.
1163 It is recommended to specify this option to improve reliability.
1164
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001165 prefix When this option is specified, haproxy will match on the cookie
1166 prefix (or URL parameter prefix). The appsession value is the
1167 data following this prefix.
1168
1169 Example :
1170 appsession ASPSESSIONID len 64 timeout 3h prefix
1171
1172 This will match the cookie ASPSESSIONIDXXXX=XXXXX,
1173 the appsession value will be XXXX=XXXXX.
1174
1175 mode This option allows to change the URL parser mode.
1176 2 modes are currently supported :
1177 - path-parameters :
1178 The parser looks for the appsession in the path parameters
1179 part (each parameter is separated by a semi-colon), which is
1180 convenient for JSESSIONID for example.
1181 This is the default mode if the option is not set.
1182 - query-string :
1183 In this mode, the parser will look for the appsession in the
1184 query string.
1185
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001186 When an application cookie is defined in a backend, HAProxy will check when
1187 the server sets such a cookie, and will store its value in a table, and
1188 associate it with the server's identifier. Up to <length> characters from
1189 the value will be retained. On each connection, haproxy will look for this
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001190 cookie both in the "Cookie:" headers, and as a URL parameter (depending on
1191 the mode used). If a known value is found, the client will be directed to the
1192 server associated with this value. Otherwise, the load balancing algorithm is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001193 applied. Cookies are automatically removed from memory when they have been
1194 unused for a duration longer than <holdtime>.
1195
1196 The definition of an application cookie is limited to one per backend.
1197
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01001198 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
1199 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
1200 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
1201
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001202 Example :
1203 appsession JSESSIONID len 52 timeout 3h
1204
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01001205 See also : "cookie", "capture cookie", "balance", "stick", "stick-table",
1206 "ignore-persist", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001207
1208
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01001209backlog <conns>
1210 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
1211 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1212 yes | yes | yes | no
1213 Arguments :
1214 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
1215 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001216 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01001217
1218 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
1219 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
1220 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
1221 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
1222 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
1223 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
1224 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
1225 backlog parameter.
1226
1227 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
1228 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
1229 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
1230
1231 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
1232
1233
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001234balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001235balance url_param <param> [check_post [<max_wait>]]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001236 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
1237 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1238 yes | no | yes | yes
1239 Arguments :
1240 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
1241 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
1242 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
1243 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
1244
1245 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
1246 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
1247 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
1248 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02001249 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
1250 design to 4128 active servers per backend. Note that in some
1251 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
1252 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
1253 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
1254 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
1255 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
1256 it, so that you don't worry.
1257
1258 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
1259 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
1260 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
1261 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
1262 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
1263 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
1264 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
1265 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001266
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01001267 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
1268 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
1269 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
1270 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
1271 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
1272 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
1273 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
1274 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance.
1275
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001276 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
1277 connection. The servers are choosen from the lowest numeric
1278 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
1279 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02001280 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001281 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
1282 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
1283 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
1284 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
1285 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02001286 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
1287 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
1288 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
1289 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
1290 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
1291 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001292
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001293 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
1294 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
1295 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
1296 address will always reach the same server as long as no
1297 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
1298 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
1299 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
1300 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001301 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001302 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001303 static by default, which means that changing a server's
1304 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
1305 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001306
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01001307 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
1308 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
1309 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
1310 the running servers. The result designates which server will
1311 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
1312 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
1313 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
1314 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
1315 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
1316 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1317 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1318 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001319
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01001320 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001321 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
1322 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
1323 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
1324 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
1325 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
1326 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
1327 URIs start with a leading "/".
1328
1329 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
1330 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
1331 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
1332 evaluation stops when either is reached.
1333
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001334 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001335 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
1336
1337 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001338 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
1339 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
1340 ('?') in the URL. Optionally, specify a number of octets to
1341 wait for before attempting to search the message body. If the
1342 entity can not be searched, then round robin is used for each
1343 request. For instance, if your clients always send the LB
1344 parameter in the first 128 bytes, then specify that. The
1345 default is 48. The entity data will not be scanned until the
1346 required number of octets have arrived at the gateway, this
1347 is the minimum of: (default/max_wait, Content-Length or first
1348 chunk length). If Content-Length is missing or zero, it does
1349 not need to wait for more data than the client promised to
1350 send. When Content-Length is present and larger than
1351 <max_wait>, then waiting is limited to <max_wait> and it is
1352 assumed that this will be enough data to search for the
1353 presence of the parameter. In the unlikely event that
1354 Transfer-Encoding: chunked is used, only the first chunk is
1355 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
1356 be randomly balanced if at all.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001357
1358 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
1359 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
1360 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
1361 server will receive the request.
1362
1363 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
1364 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
1365 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
1366 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
1367 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001368 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
1369 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
1370 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001371
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001372 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
1373 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
1374 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
1375 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
1376 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001377
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001378 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001379 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
1380 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
1381 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
1382
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001383 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1384 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1385 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
1386
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001387 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02001388 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001389 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
1390 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
1391 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
1392 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
1393 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
1394 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001395 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001396 used instead.
1397
1398 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
1399 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
1400 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
1401 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
1402
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001403 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1404 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1405 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
1406
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001407 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09001408
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001409 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001410 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
1411 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001412
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001413 balance uri [len <len>] [depth <depth>]
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001414 balance url_param <param> [check_post [<max_wait>]]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001415
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01001416 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
1417 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
1418 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001419
1420 Examples :
1421 balance roundrobin
1422 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001423 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001424 balance hdr(User-Agent)
1425 balance hdr(host)
1426 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001427
1428 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
1429 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
1430
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001431 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001432 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
1433 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
1434 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
1435 the body. (see acl reqideny http_end)
1436
1437 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
1438 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
1439 defaults to 16 kB.
1440
1441 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
1442 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
1443
1444 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
1445 Round Robin.
1446
1447 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC2616 3.6.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
1448 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
1449 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
1450 actually appeared in the first chunk).
1451
1452 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
1453
1454 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001455 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001456 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
1457 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
1458 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001459
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001460 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "appsession", "transparent", "hash-type" and
1461 "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001462
1463
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02001464bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
1465bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001466 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
1467 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1468 no | yes | yes | no
1469 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01001470 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
1471 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
1472 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
1473 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01001474 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01001475
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001476 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
1477 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001478 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
1479 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
1480 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001481 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
1482 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
1483 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
1484 the range.
1485
1486 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
1487 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
1488 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
1489 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
1490 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
1491 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
1492 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001493 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001494 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001495
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001496 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
1497 alternative to the TCP listening port. Haproxy will then
1498 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
1499 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
1500 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
1501 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
1502 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
1503 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
1504
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02001505 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
1506 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
1507 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
1508 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02001509
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001510 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
1511 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
1512 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
1513 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
1514 in a frontend.
1515
1516 Example :
1517 listen http_proxy
1518 bind :80,:443
1519 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001520 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001521
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02001522 listen http_https_proxy
1523 bind :80
1524 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem prefer-server-ciphers
1525
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001526 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02001527 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001528
1529
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001530bind-process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-32> ] ...
1531 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
1532 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1533 yes | yes | yes | yes
1534 Arguments :
1535 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
1536 may be used to override a default value.
1537
1538 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...31. This
1539 option may be combined with other numbers.
1540
1541 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...32. This
1542 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
1543 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
1544 missing from all processes.
1545
1546 number The instance will be enabled on this process number, between
1547 1 and 32. You must be careful not to reference a process
1548 number greater than the configured global.nbproc, otherwise
1549 some instances might be missing from all processes.
1550
1551 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
1552 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
1553 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
1554 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
1555 and 'even' instances.
1556
1557 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 processes using
1558 this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups. Please
1559 note that 'all' really means all processes and is not limited to the first
1560 32.
1561
1562 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
1563 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
1564
1565 Example :
1566 listen app_ip1
1567 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001568 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001569
1570 listen app_ip2
1571 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001572 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001573
1574 listen management
1575 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001576 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001577
1578 See also : "nbproc" in global section.
1579
1580
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001581block { if | unless } <condition>
1582 Block a layer 7 request if/unless a condition is matched
1583 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1584 no | yes | yes | yes
1585
1586 The HTTP request will be blocked very early in the layer 7 processing
1587 if/unless <condition> is matched. A 403 error will be returned if the request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001588 is blocked. The condition has to reference ACLs (see section 7). This is
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02001589 typically used to deny access to certain sensitive resources if some
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001590 conditions are met or not met. There is no fixed limit to the number of
1591 "block" statements per instance.
1592
1593 Example:
1594 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
1595 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
1596 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
1597 block if invalid_src || local_dst
1598
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001599 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001600
1601
1602capture cookie <name> len <length>
1603 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
1604 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1605 no | yes | yes | no
1606 Arguments :
1607 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
1608 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
1609 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
1610 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
1611 and value (eg: ASPSESSIONXXXXX).
1612
1613 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
1614 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
1615 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
1616 right if it exceeds <length>.
1617
1618 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
1619 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
1620 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
1621 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
1622
1623 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
1624 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
1625 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
1626
1627 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
1628 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
1629 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
1630 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001631 configured in the sources by default to 64 characters. It is not possible to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001632 specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
1633
1634 Example:
1635 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
1636
1637 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001638 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001639
1640
1641capture request header <name> len <length>
1642 Capture and log the first occurrence of the specified request header.
1643 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1644 no | yes | yes | no
1645 Arguments :
1646 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01001647 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001648 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
1649 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
1650 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
1651
1652 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
1653 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
1654 it exceeds <length>.
1655
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001656 Only the first value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001657 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
1658 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001659 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
1660 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
1661 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
1662 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001663 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001664 environments to find where the request came from.
1665
1666 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
1667 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
1668 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
1669 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001670
1671 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers, but each capture
1672 is limited to 64 characters. In order to keep log format consistent for a
1673 same frontend, header captures can only be declared in a frontend. It is not
1674 possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
1675
1676 Example:
1677 capture request header Host len 15
1678 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
1679 capture request header Referrer len 15
1680
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001681 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001682 about logging.
1683
1684
1685capture response header <name> len <length>
1686 Capture and log the first occurrence of the specified response header.
1687 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1688 no | yes | yes | no
1689 Arguments :
1690 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01001691 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001692 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
1693 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
1694 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
1695
1696 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
1697 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
1698 it exceeds <length>.
1699
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001700 Only the first value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001701 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
1702 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
1703 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001704 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
1705 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
1706 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
1707 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001708
1709 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers, but each
1710 capture is limited to 64 characters. In order to keep log format consistent
1711 for a same frontend, header captures can only be declared in a frontend. It
1712 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
1713
1714 Example:
1715 capture response header Content-length len 9
1716 capture response header Location len 15
1717
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001718 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001719 about logging.
1720
1721
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001722clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001723 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
1724 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1725 yes | yes | yes | no
1726 Arguments :
1727 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
1728 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
1729 as explained at the top of this document.
1730
1731 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
1732 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
1733 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
1734 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
1735 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
1736 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
1737 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
1738 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01001739 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001740 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
1741 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds).
1742
1743 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
1744 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
1745 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
1746 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
1747 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
1748 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
1749
1750 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
1751 Please use "timeout client" instead.
1752
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01001753 See also : "timeout client", "timeout http-request", "timeout server", and
1754 "srvtimeout".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001755
1756
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001757contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001758 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
1759 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1760 yes | no | yes | yes
1761 Arguments :
1762 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
1763 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
1764 as explained at the top of this document.
1765
1766 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01001767 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001768 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001769 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
1770 connect timeout also presets the queue timeout to the same value if this one
1771 has not been specified. Historically, the contimeout was also used to set the
1772 tarpit timeout in a listen section, which is not possible in a pure frontend.
1773
1774 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
1775 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
1776 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
1777 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
1778 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
1779 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
1780
1781 This parameter is provided for backwards compatibility but is currently
1782 deprecated. Please use "timeout connect", "timeout queue" or "timeout tarpit"
1783 instead.
1784
1785 See also : "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout tarpit",
1786 "timeout server", "contimeout".
1787
1788
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02001789cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02001790 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
1791 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001792 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
1793 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1794 yes | no | yes | yes
1795 Arguments :
1796 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
1797 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
1798 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
1799 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
1800 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
1801 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
1802 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (eg:
1803 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
1804 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
1805
1806 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
1807 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
1808 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
1809 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
1810 headers is left to the application. The application can then
1811 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
1812 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode only
1813 works in HTTP close mode. Unless the application behaviour is
1814 very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to start with this
1815 mode for new deployments. This keyword is incompatible with
1816 "insert" and "prefix".
1817
1818 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02001819 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02001820
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02001821 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02001822 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
1823 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be remove before
1824 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
1825 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
1826 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
1827 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
1828 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
1829 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
1830 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
1831 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001832
1833 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
1834 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
1835 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
1836 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
1837 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
1838 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
1839 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
1840 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
1841 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
1842 this mode requires the HTTP close mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02001843 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
1844 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
1845 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001846
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02001847 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
1848 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
1849 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02001850 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
1851 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
1852 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
1853 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02001854 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
1855 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
1856 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001857
1858 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
1859 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
1860 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
1861 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
1862 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
1863 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
1864 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
1865 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
1866 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
1867
1868 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
1869 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
1870 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
1871 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
1872 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
1873 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
1874 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
1875 persistence cookie in the cache.
1876 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
1877
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02001878 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
1879 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
1880 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
1881 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
1882 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
1883 emit a cookie with an invalid value (eg: empty) or with a date in
1884 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
1885 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
1886 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
1887 they logout.
1888
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02001889 httponly This option tells haproxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
1890 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
1891 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
1892 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
1893
1894 secure This option tells haproxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
1895 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
1896 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
1897 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
1898 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
1899 this attribute.
1900
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02001901 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001902 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01001903 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
1904 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
1905 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
1906 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
1907 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
1908 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02001909
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02001910 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
1911 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
1912 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
1913 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
1914 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
1915 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
1916 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
1917 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
1918 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). When
1919 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
1920 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
1921 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
1922 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
1923 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
1924 the site.
1925
1926 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
1927 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
1928 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
1929 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
1930 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
1931 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
1932 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
1933 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
1934 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
1935 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
1936 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
1937 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
1938 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
1939 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). This
1940 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
1941 redispatch after some absolute delay.
1942
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001943 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
1944 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
1945 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
1946 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001947
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001948 Examples :
1949 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
1950 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
1951 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02001952 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001953
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02001954 See also : "appsession", "balance source", "capture cookie", "server"
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001955 and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001956
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01001957
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01001958default-server [param*]
1959 Change default options for a server in a backend
1960 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1961 yes | no | yes | yes
1962 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01001963 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
1964 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
1965 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
1966 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01001967
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01001968 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01001969 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
1970
1971 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001972
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01001973
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001974default_backend <backend>
1975 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
1976 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1977 yes | yes | yes | no
1978 Arguments :
1979 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
1980
1981 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
1982 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
1983 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
1984 will catch all undetermined requests.
1985
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001986 Example :
1987
1988 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
1989 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
1990 default_backend dynamic
1991
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01001992 See also : "use_backend", "reqsetbe", "reqisetbe"
1993
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001994
1995disabled
1996 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
1997 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1998 yes | yes | yes | yes
1999 Arguments : none
2000
2001 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
2002 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
2003 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
2004 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
2005 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
2006 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
2007 keyword in a "defaults" section.
2008
2009 See also : "enabled"
2010
2011
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002012dispatch <address>:<port>
2013 Set a default server address
2014 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2015 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02002016 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002017
2018 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
2019 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
2020 during start-up.
2021
2022 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
2023 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
2024 possible with normal servers.
2025
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02002026 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002027 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
2028 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
2029 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
2030 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
2031
2032 See also : "server"
2033
2034
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002035enabled
2036 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
2037 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2038 yes | yes | yes | yes
2039 Arguments : none
2040
2041 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
2042 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
2043
2044 See also : "disabled"
2045
2046
2047errorfile <code> <file>
2048 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2049 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2050 yes | yes | yes | yes
2051 Arguments :
2052 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002053 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002054
2055 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002056 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002057 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002058 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
2059 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002060
2061 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2062 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2063 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2064
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002065 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2066
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002067 The files are returned verbatim on the TCP socket. This allows any trick such
2068 as redirections to another URL or site, as well as tricks to clean cookies,
2069 force enable or disable caching, etc... The package provides default error
2070 files returning the same contents as default errors.
2071
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002072 The files should not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFSIZE), which
2073 generally is 8 or 16 kB, otherwise they will be truncated. It is also wise
2074 not to put any reference to local contents (eg: images) in order to avoid
2075 loops between the client and HAProxy when all servers are down, causing an
2076 error to be returned instead of an image. For better HTTP compliance, it is
2077 recommended that all header lines end with CR-LF and not LF alone.
2078
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002079 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
2080 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
2081 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01002082 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002083 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
2084
2085 See also : "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
2086
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002087 Example :
2088 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
2089 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
2090 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
2091
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002092
2093errorloc <code> <url>
2094errorloc302 <code> <url>
2095 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2096 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2097 yes | yes | yes | yes
2098 Arguments :
2099 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002100 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002101
2102 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
2103 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
2104 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
2105 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
2106 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
2107
2108 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2109 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2110 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2111
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002112 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2113
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002114 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
2115 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
2116 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
2117 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
2118 workaround this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
2119 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
2120 request.
2121
2122 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc303"
2123
2124
2125errorloc303 <code> <url>
2126 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2127 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2128 yes | yes | yes | yes
2129 Arguments :
2130 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
2131 generating codes 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
2132
2133 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
2134 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
2135 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
2136 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
2137 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
2138
2139 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2140 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2141 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2142
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002143 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2144
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002145 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
2146 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
2147 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
2148 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002149 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002150
2151 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
2152
2153
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01002154force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
2155 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
2156 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2157 no | yes | yes | yes
2158
2159 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
2160 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
2161 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
2162 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
2163 marked down for maintenance operations.
2164
2165 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
2166 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
2167 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
2168 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
2169 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
2170 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
2171 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
2172 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
2173 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
2174
2175 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
2176 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
2177 is used.
2178
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02002179 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02002180 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01002181
2182
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002183fullconn <conns>
2184 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
2185 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2186 yes | no | yes | yes
2187 Arguments :
2188 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
2189 servers use the maximal number of connections.
2190
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002191 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002192 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002193 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002194 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
2195 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
2196 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
2197 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
2198 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002199 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002200
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02002201 Since it's hard to get this value right, haproxy automatically sets it to
2202 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
2203 backend. That way it's safe to leave it unset.
2204
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002205 Example :
2206 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
2207 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
2208 # connections.
2209 backend dynamic
2210 fullconn 10000
2211 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
2212 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
2213
2214 See also : "maxconn", "server"
2215
2216
2217grace <time>
2218 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
2219 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01002220 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002221 Arguments :
2222 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
2223 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
2224 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
2225
2226 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
2227 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002228 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002229 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
2230
2231 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
2232 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
2233 simplify it.
2234
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002235
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002236hash-type <method>
2237 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
2238 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2239 yes | no | yes | yes
2240 Arguments :
2241 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
2242 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but will
2243 be static in that weight changes while a server is up will be
2244 ignored. This means that there will be no slow start. Also,
2245 since a server is selected by its position in the array, most
2246 mappings are changed when the server count changes. This means
2247 that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is added
2248 to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to different
2249 servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for instance.
2250
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01002251 avalanche this mechanism uses the default map-based hashing described
2252 above but applies a full avalanche hash before performing the
2253 mapping. The result is a slightly less smooth hash for most
2254 situations, but the hash becomes better than pure map-based
2255 hashes when the number of servers is a multiple of the size of
2256 the input set. When using URI hash with a number of servers
2257 multiple of 64, it's desirable to change the hash type to
2258 this value.
2259
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002260 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
2261 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
2262 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
2263 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
2264 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
2265 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a server
2266 is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings are
2267 redistributed, making it an ideal algorithm for caches.
2268 However, due to its principle, the algorithm will never be very
2269 smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a server's
2270 weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution. In order
2271 to get the same distribution on multiple load balancers, it is
2272 important that all servers have the same IDs.
2273
2274 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages.
2275
2276 See also : "balance", "server"
2277
2278
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002279http-check disable-on-404
2280 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
2281 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002282 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002283 Arguments : none
2284
2285 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
2286 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
2287 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
2288 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
2289 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
2290 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
2291 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
2292 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002293 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
2294 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
2295 responses will still be considered as soft-stop.
2296
2297 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check expect"
2298
2299
2300http-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002301 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002302 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02002303 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002304 Arguments :
2305 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
2306 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002307 "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002308 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
2309 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
2310 details on the supported keywords.
2311
2312 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
2313 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
2314 with the usual backslash ('\').
2315
2316 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
2317 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
2318 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
2319 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
2320 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
2321
2322 status <string> : test the exact string match for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002323 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002324 response's status code is exactly this string. If the
2325 "status" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2326 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
2327
2328 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002329 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002330 response's status code matches the expression. If the
2331 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2332 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
2333 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
2334
2335 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002336 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002337 response's body contains this exact string. If the
2338 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2339 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
2340 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
2341 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
2342 specific error appears on the check page (eg: a stack
2343 trace).
2344
2345 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002346 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002347 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
2348 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
2349 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
2350 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
2351 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
2352 error appears on the check page (eg: a stack trace).
2353
2354 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
2355 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
2356 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
2357 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
2358 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
2359 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
2360 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
2361 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
2362
2363 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
2364 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
2365
2366 Examples :
2367 # only accept status 200 as valid
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002368 http-check expect status 200
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002369
2370 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002371 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002372
2373 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002374 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002375
2376 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002377 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*</html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002378
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002379 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002380
2381
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01002382http-check send-state
2383 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
2384 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2385 yes | no | yes | yes
2386 Arguments : none
2387
2388 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
2389 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
2390 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
2391 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
2392 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
2393
2394 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
2395 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
2396 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
2397 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
2398 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
2399 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
2400 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
2401 checked in multiple backends.
2402
2403 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
2404 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
2405
2406 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
2407 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
2408 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
2409 one fails.
2410
2411 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
2412 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
2413 connections on all servers of the same backend.
2414
2415 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
2416 server's queue.
2417
2418 Example of a header received by the application server :
2419 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
2420 scur=13/22; qcur=0
2421
2422 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
2423
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02002424http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002425 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002426 Access control for Layer 7 requests
2427
2428 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2429 no | yes | yes | yes
2430
2431 These set of options allow to fine control access to a
2432 frontend/listen/backend. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
2433 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02002434 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
2435 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002436 should be asked to enter a username and password.
2437
2438 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
2439 instance.
2440
2441 Example:
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002442 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
2443 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
2444 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002445
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002446 http-request allow if nagios
2447 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
2448 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
2449 http-request deny
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002450
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002451 Example:
2452 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002453
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002454 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002455
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02002456 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
2457 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01002458
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05002459http-send-name-header [<header>]
2460 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
2461
2462 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2463 yes | no | yes | yes
2464
2465 Arguments :
2466
2467 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
2468
2469 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the name of the target
2470 server to be added to the headers of an HTTP request. The name
2471 is added with the header string proved.
2472
2473 See also : "server"
2474
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01002475id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02002476 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
2477 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2478 no | yes | yes | yes
2479 Arguments : none
2480
2481 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
2482 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
2483 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01002484
2485
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02002486ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
2487 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
2488 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2489 no | yes | yes | yes
2490
2491 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
2492 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
2493 and running).
2494
2495 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
2496 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
2497 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
2498 oftenly don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
2499 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
2500
2501 Combined with "appsession", it can also help reduce HAProxy memory usage, as
2502 the appsession table won't grow if persistence is ignored.
2503
2504 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
2505 "unless" condition is met.
2506
2507 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
2508
2509
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002510log global
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02002511log <address> <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02002512no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002513 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
2514 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2515 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02002516
2517 Prefix :
2518 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
2519 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
2520 prefix does not allow arguments.
2521
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002522 Arguments :
2523 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
2524 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
2525 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
2526 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
2527 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
2528 parameter.
2529
2530 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
2531 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
2532
2533 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
2534 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
2535 standard syslog port).
2536
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01002537 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
2538 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
2539 standard syslog port).
2540
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002541 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
2542 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
2543 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
2544 appropriately writeable).
2545
2546 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
2547
2548 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
2549 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
2550 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
2551
2552 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
2553 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
2554 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02002555 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
2556 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
2557 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
2558 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
2559 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002560
2561 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
2562
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02002563 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
2564 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
2565 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002566
2567 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
2568 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
2569 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
2570 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
2571
2572 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
2573 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002574
2575 Example :
2576 log global
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02002577 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
2578 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output level
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002579
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01002580log-format <string>
2581 Allows you to custom a log line.
2582
2583 See also : Custom Log Format (8.2.4)
2584
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002585
2586maxconn <conns>
2587 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
2588 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2589 yes | yes | yes | no
2590 Arguments :
2591 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
2592 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
2593 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
2594 closes.
2595
2596 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
2597 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
2598 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
2599 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
2600 of 8kB each, as well as some other data resulting in about 17 kB of RAM being
2601 consumed per established connection. That means that a medium system equipped
2602 with 1GB of RAM can withstand around 40000-50000 concurrent connections if
2603 properly tuned.
2604
2605 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
2606 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
2607 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
2608
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02002609 By default, this value is set to 2000.
2610
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002611 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
2612
2613
2614mode { tcp|http|health }
2615 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
2616 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2617 yes | yes | yes | yes
2618 Arguments :
2619 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
2620 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
2621 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
2622 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
2623
2624 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
2625 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
2626 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
2627 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
2628 brings HAProxy most of its value.
2629
2630 health The instance will work in "health" mode. It will just reply "OK"
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02002631 to incoming connections and close the connection. Alternatively,
2632 If the "httpchk" option is set, "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" will be sent
2633 instead. Nothing will be logged in either case. This mode is used
2634 to reply to external components health checks. This mode is
2635 deprecated and should not be used anymore as it is possible to do
2636 the same and even better by combining TCP or HTTP modes with the
2637 "monitor" keyword.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002638
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02002639 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
2640 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
2641 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002642
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02002643 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002644 defaults http_instances
2645 mode http
2646
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02002647 See also : "monitor", "monitor-net"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002648
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002649
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002650monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002651 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002652 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2653 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002654 Arguments :
2655 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
2656 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002657 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002658 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
2659 backend and its backup.
2660
2661 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
2662 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
2663 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
2664 servers in a list of backends.
2665
2666 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
2667 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
2668 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
2669 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
2670 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
2671 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
2672 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002673 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
2674 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002675
2676 Example:
2677 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002678 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002679 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
2680 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
2681 monitor-uri /site_alive
2682 monitor fail if site_dead
2683
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002684 See also : "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002685
2686
2687monitor-net <source>
2688 Declare a source network which is limited to monitor requests
2689 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2690 yes | yes | yes | no
2691 Arguments :
2692 <source> is the source IPv4 address or network which will only be able to
2693 get monitor responses to any request. It can be either an IPv4
2694 address, a host name, or an address followed by a slash ('/')
2695 followed by a mask.
2696
2697 In TCP mode, any connection coming from a source matching <source> will cause
2698 the connection to be immediately closed without any log. This allows another
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002699 equipment to probe the port and verify that it is still listening, without
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002700 forwarding the connection to a remote server.
2701
2702 In HTTP mode, a connection coming from a source matching <source> will be
2703 accepted, the following response will be sent without waiting for a request,
2704 then the connection will be closed : "HTTP/1.0 200 OK". This is normally
2705 enough for any front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02002706 running without forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that this
2707 response is sent in raw format, without any transformation. This is important
2708 as it means that it will not be SSL-encrypted on SSL listeners.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002709
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02002710 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after tcp-request connection
2711 ACLs which are the only ones able to block them. These connections are short
2712 lived and never wait for any data from the client. They cannot be logged, and
2713 it is the intended purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to
2714 an upper component, nothing more. Please note that "monitor fail" rules do
2715 not apply to connections intercepted by "monitor-net".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002716
Willy Tarreau95cd2832010-03-04 23:36:33 +01002717 Last, please note that only one "monitor-net" statement can be specified in
2718 a frontend. If more than one is found, only the last one will be considered.
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02002719
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002720 Example :
2721 # addresses .252 and .253 are just probing us.
2722 frontend www
2723 monitor-net 192.168.0.252/31
2724
2725 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-uri"
2726
2727
2728monitor-uri <uri>
2729 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
2730 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2731 yes | yes | yes | no
2732 Arguments :
2733 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
2734 health status instead of forwarding the request.
2735
2736 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
2737 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
2738 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
2739 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
2740 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
2741 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
2742 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
2743 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
2744
2745 Monitor requests are processed very early. It is not possible to block nor
2746 divert them using ACLs. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
2747 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
2748 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
2749 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
2750 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
2751
2752 Example :
2753 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
2754 frontend www
2755 mode http
2756 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
2757
2758 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-net"
2759
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002760
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002761option abortonclose
2762no option abortonclose
2763 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
2764 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2765 yes | no | yes | yes
2766 Arguments : none
2767
2768 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
2769 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
2770 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
2771 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002772 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002773 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
2774 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
2775 encountered while delivering the response.
2776
2777 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
2778 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
2779 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
2780 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
2781 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
2782 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01002783 support this behaviour (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002784 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002785 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002786 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
2787 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
2788 still not served and not pollute the servers.
2789
2790 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behaviour using the option
2791 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behaviour is HTTP
2792 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
2793 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
2794 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
2795 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
2796 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
2797 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01002798 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002799
2800 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
2801 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
2802
2803 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
2804
2805
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02002806option accept-invalid-http-request
2807no option accept-invalid-http-request
2808 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
2809 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2810 yes | yes | yes | no
2811 Arguments : none
2812
2813 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC2616 in terms of message parsing. This
2814 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
2815 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
2816 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
2817 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
2818 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
2819 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
2820 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01002821 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
2822 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
2823 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
2824 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
2825 not allowed at all. Haproxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
2826 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02002827
2828 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
2829 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
2830 been confirmed.
2831
2832 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
2833 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01002834 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
2835 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02002836 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
2837
2838 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
2839 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
2840
2841 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
2842 stats socket.
2843
2844
2845option accept-invalid-http-response
2846no option accept-invalid-http-response
2847 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
2848 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2849 yes | no | yes | yes
2850 Arguments : none
2851
2852 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC2616 in terms of message parsing. This
2853 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
2854 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
2855 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
2856 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
2857 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
2858 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
2859 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
2860 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option.
2861
2862 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
2863 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
2864 been confirmed.
2865
2866 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
2867 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
2868 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
2869 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
2870
2871 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
2872 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
2873
2874 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
2875 stats socket.
2876
2877
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002878option allbackups
2879no option allbackups
2880 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
2881 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2882 yes | no | yes | yes
2883 Arguments : none
2884
2885 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
2886 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
2887 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
2888 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
2889 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
2890 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
2891 order between the backup servers anymore.
2892
2893 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
2894 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
2895
2896 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
2897 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
2898
2899
2900option checkcache
2901no option checkcache
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002902 Analyze all server responses and block requests with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002903 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2904 yes | no | yes | yes
2905 Arguments : none
2906
2907 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
2908 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002909 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002910 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
2911 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02002912 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002913
2914 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002915 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002916 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002917 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
2918 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002919 to the client are :
2920 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002921 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 206, 300, 301, 410,
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002922 provided that the server has not set a "Cache-control: public" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002923 - all those that come from a POST request, provided that the server has not
2924 set a 'Cache-Control: public' header ;
2925 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
2926 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
2927 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
2928 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
2929 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
2930 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
2931 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
2932 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
2933 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
2934
2935 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002936 just as if it was from an "rspdeny" filter, with an "HTTP 502 bad gateway".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002937 The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the response
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002938 during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in the logs so
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002939 that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
2940
2941 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
2942 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002943 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002944 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviours.
2945
2946 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
2947 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
2948
2949
2950option clitcpka
2951no option clitcpka
2952 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
2953 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2954 yes | yes | yes | no
2955 Arguments : none
2956
2957 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
2958 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
2959 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
2960 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
2961
2962 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
2963 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
2964 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
2965 operating system and its tuning parameters.
2966
2967 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
2968 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
2969 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
2970 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
2971 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
2972
2973 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
2974
2975 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
2976 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
2977 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
2978
2979 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
2980 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
2981
2982 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
2983
2984
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002985option contstats
2986 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
2987 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2988 yes | yes | yes | no
2989 Arguments : none
2990
2991 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
2992 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
2993 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
2994 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
2995 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented continuously,
2996 during a whole session. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so
2997 it is not enabled by default, as it has small performance impact (~0.5%).
2998
2999
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02003000option dontlog-normal
3001no option dontlog-normal
3002 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
3003 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3004 yes | yes | yes | no
3005 Arguments : none
3006
3007 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
3008 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
3009 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
3010 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
3011 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
3012 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
3013 logged.
3014
3015 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
3016 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
3017 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
3018
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003019 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02003020 logging.
3021
3022
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003023option dontlognull
3024no option dontlognull
3025 Enable or disable logging of null connections
3026 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3027 yes | yes | yes | no
3028 Arguments : none
3029
3030 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
3031 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
3032 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
3033 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
3034 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
3035 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
3036 which typically corresponds to those probes.
3037
3038 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
3039 environments (eg: internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
3040 would not be logged.
3041
3042 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3043 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3044
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003045 See also : "log", "monitor-net", "monitor-uri" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003046
3047
3048option forceclose
3049no option forceclose
3050 Enable or disable active connection closing after response is transferred.
3051 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaua31e5df2009-12-30 01:10:35 +01003052 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003053 Arguments : none
3054
3055 Some HTTP servers do not necessarily close the connections when they receive
3056 the "Connection: close" set by "option httpclose", and if the client does not
3057 close either, then the connection remains open till the timeout expires. This
3058 causes high number of simultaneous connections on the servers and shows high
3059 global session times in the logs.
3060
3061 When this happens, it is possible to use "option forceclose". It will
Willy Tarreau82eeaf22009-12-29 12:09:05 +01003062 actively close the outgoing server channel as soon as the server has finished
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01003063 to respond. This option implicitly enables the "httpclose" option. Note that
3064 this option also enables the parsing of the full request and response, which
3065 means we can close the connection to the server very quickly, releasing some
3066 resources earlier than with httpclose.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003067
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003068 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
3069 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
3070 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
3071
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003072 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3073 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3074
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003075 See also : "option httpclose" and "option http-pretend-keepalive"
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003076
3077
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003078option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003079 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
3080 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3081 yes | yes | yes | yes
3082 Arguments :
3083 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
3084 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003085 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003086 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003087
3088 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
3089 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
3090 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
3091 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
3092 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
3093 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
3094 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003095 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
3096 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
3097 possible that the client has already brought one.
3098
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003099 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003100 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003101 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (eg: stunnel),
3102 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003103 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (eg: Zeus Web Servers
3104 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003105
3106 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
3107 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
3108 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
3109 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
3110 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
3111 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
3112 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
3113
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003114 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
3115 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
3116 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching haproxy
3117 are under the control of the end-user.
3118
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003119 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003120 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
3121 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003122 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
3123 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
3124 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003125
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003126 It is important to note that by default, HAProxy works in tunnel mode and
3127 only inspects the first request of a connection, meaning that only the first
3128 request will have the header appended, which is certainly not what you want.
3129 In order to fix this, ensure that any of the "httpclose", "forceclose" or
3130 "http-server-close" options is set when using this option.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003131
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003132 Examples :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003133 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
3134 frontend www
3135 mode http
3136 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
3137
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003138 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
3139 backend www
3140 mode http
3141 option forwardfor header X-Client
3142
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003143 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
3144 "option forceclose"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003145
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003146
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02003147option http-no-delay
3148no option http-no-delay
3149 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
3150 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3151 yes | yes | yes | yes
3152 Arguments : none
3153
3154 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
3155 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
3156 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
3157 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
3158 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
3159 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
3160 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
3161 haproxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
3162 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
3163 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
3164 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
3165 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
3166 affected.
3167
3168 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
3169 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
3170 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
3171 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
3172 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
3173 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
3174 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
3175 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
3176 latency environments.
3177
3178
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003179option http-pretend-keepalive
3180no option http-pretend-keepalive
3181 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
3182 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3183 yes | yes | yes | yes
3184 Arguments : none
3185
3186 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option forceclose", haproxy
3187 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
3188 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
3189 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
3190 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
3191 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
3192 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
3193 consider the response complete.
3194
3195 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
3196 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
3197 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
3198 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
3199 "forceclose" option. That way the client gets a normal response and the
3200 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
3201
3202 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
3203 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
3204 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
3205 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
3206 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
3207 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
3208 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
3209
3210 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
3211 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003212 This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will cause
Willy Tarreau22a95342010-09-29 14:31:41 +02003213 keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to the
3214 client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003215
3216 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3217 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3218
3219 See also : "option forceclose" and "option http-server-close"
3220
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003221
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003222option http-server-close
3223no option http-server-close
3224 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
3225 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3226 yes | yes | yes | yes
3227 Arguments : none
3228
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02003229 By default, when a client communicates with a server, HAProxy will only
3230 analyze, log, and process the first request of each connection. Setting
3231 "option http-server-close" enables HTTP connection-close mode on the server
3232 side while keeping the ability to support HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on
3233 the client side. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
3234 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side to save server
3235 resources, similarly to "option forceclose". It also permits non-keepalive
3236 capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode to the clients if they
3237 conform to the requirements of RFC2616. Please note that some servers do not
3238 always conform to those requirements when they see "Connection: close" in the
3239 request. The effect will be that keep-alive will never be used. A workaround
3240 consists in enabling "option http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003241
3242 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
3243 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
3244 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
3245 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01003246 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
3247 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003248
3249 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
3250 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01003251 It is worth noting that "option forceclose" has precedence over "option
3252 http-server-close" and that combining "http-server-close" with "httpclose"
3253 basically achieve the same result as "forceclose".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003254
3255 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3256 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3257
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02003258 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
3259 "option httpclose" and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003260
3261
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01003262option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003263no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01003264 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
3265 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3266 yes | yes | yes | no
3267 Arguments : none
3268
3269 While RFC2616 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
3270 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
3271 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
3272 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
3273 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
3274 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
3275 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
3276
3277 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
3278 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
3279 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. The
3280 choice of header only affects requests passing through proxies making use of
3281 one of the "httpclose", "forceclose" and "http-server-close" options. Note
3282 that this option can only be specified in a frontend and will affect the
3283 request along its whole life.
3284
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01003285 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
3286 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
3287 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
3288 front of an existing proxy.
3289
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01003290 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
3291
3292 See also : "option httpclose", "option forceclose" and "option
3293 http-server-close".
3294
3295
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01003296option httpchk
3297option httpchk <uri>
3298option httpchk <method> <uri>
3299option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
3300 Enable HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
3301 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3302 yes | no | yes | yes
3303 Arguments :
3304 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
3305 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
3306 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
3307 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
3308 ones.
3309
3310 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
3311 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
3312 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
3313
3314 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
3315 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
3316 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
3317 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, and as a trick, it is possible to pass it
3318 after "\r\n" following the version string.
3319
3320 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
3321 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
3322 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
3323 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
3324 the lack of any response.
3325
3326 The port and interval are specified in the server configuration.
3327
3328 This option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works with
3329 plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts bound
3330 to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon.
3331
3332 Examples :
3333 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
3334 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
3335 backend https_relay
3336 mode tcp
3337 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1\r\nHost:\ www
3338 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
3339
3340 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
Rauf Kuliyev38b41562011-01-04 15:14:13 +01003341 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
3342 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01003343
3344
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003345option httpclose
3346no option httpclose
3347 Enable or disable passive HTTP connection closing
3348 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3349 yes | yes | yes | yes
3350 Arguments : none
3351
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02003352 By default, when a client communicates with a server, HAProxy will only
3353 analyze, log, and process the first request of each connection. If "option
3354 httpclose" is set, it will check if a "Connection: close" header is already
3355 set in each direction, and will add one if missing. Each end should react to
3356 this by actively closing the TCP connection after each transfer, thus
3357 resulting in a switch to the HTTP close mode. Any "Connection" header
3358 different from "close" will also be removed.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003359
3360 It seldom happens that some servers incorrectly ignore this header and do not
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003361 close the connection even though they reply "Connection: close". For this
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01003362 reason, they are not compatible with older HTTP 1.0 browsers. If this happens
3363 it is possible to use the "option forceclose" which actively closes the
3364 request connection once the server responds. Option "forceclose" also
3365 releases the server connection earlier because it does not have to wait for
3366 the client to acknowledge it.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003367
3368 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
3369 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
3370 If "option forceclose" is specified too, it has precedence over "httpclose".
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01003371 If "option http-server-close" is enabled at the same time as "httpclose", it
3372 basically achieves the same result as "option forceclose".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003373
3374 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3375 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3376
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02003377 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close" and
3378 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003379
3380
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02003381option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003382 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
3383 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3384 yes | yes | yes | yes
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02003385 Arguments :
3386 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
3387 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
3388 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
3389 log analyser which only support the CLF format and which is not
3390 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003391
3392 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
3393 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
3394 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
3395 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
3396 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
3397 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
3398 ports.
3399
3400 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
3401
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02003402 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3403 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it. Specifying
3404 only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode if it was set
3405 by default.
3406
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003407 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003408
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003409
3410option http_proxy
3411no option http_proxy
3412 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
3413 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3414 yes | yes | yes | yes
3415 Arguments : none
3416
3417 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
3418 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
3419 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
3420 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
3421 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
3422
3423 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
3424 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
3425 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. Last,
3426 if the clients are susceptible of sending keep-alive requests, it will be
Cyril Bonté2409e682010-12-14 22:47:51 +01003427 needed to add "option httpclose" to ensure that all requests will correctly
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003428 be analyzed.
3429
3430 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3431 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3432
3433 Example :
3434 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
3435 backend direct_forward
3436 option httpclose
3437 option http_proxy
3438
3439 See also : "option httpclose"
3440
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02003441
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003442option independent-streams
3443no option independent-streams
3444 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02003445 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3446 yes | yes | yes | yes
3447 Arguments : none
3448
3449 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
3450 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
3451 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
3452 receive data or not.
3453
3454 While this default behaviour is desirable for almost all applications, there
3455 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
3456 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
3457 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
3458 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
3459 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
3460 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
3461 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
3462 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
3463 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
3464 socket buffers.
3465
3466 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
3467 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
3468 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
3469 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
3470 slow lines, so use it with caution.
3471
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003472 Note: older versions used to call this setting "option independant-streams"
3473 with a spelling mistake. This spelling is still supported but
3474 deprecated.
3475
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02003476 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02003477
3478
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02003479option ldap-check
3480 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
3481 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3482 yes | no | yes | yes
3483 Arguments : none
3484
3485 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
3486 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
3487 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
3488 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
3489
3490 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
3491 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
3492
3493 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
3494 configure it.
3495
3496 Example :
3497 option ldap-check
3498
3499 See also : "option httpchk"
3500
3501
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02003502option log-health-checks
3503no option log-health-checks
3504 Enable or disable logging of health checks
3505 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3506 yes | no | yes | yes
3507 Arguments : none
3508
3509 Enable health checks logging so it possible to check for example what
3510 was happening before a server crash. Failed health check are logged if
3511 server is UP and succeeded health checks if server is DOWN, so the amount
3512 of additional information is limited.
3513
3514 If health check logging is enabled no health check status is printed
3515 when servers is set up UP/DOWN/ENABLED/DISABLED.
3516
3517 See also: "log" and section 8 about logging.
3518
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02003519
3520option log-separate-errors
3521no option log-separate-errors
3522 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
3523 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3524 yes | yes | yes | no
3525 Arguments : none
3526
3527 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
3528 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
3529 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
3530 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
3531 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
3532 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
3533 provides very important information.
3534
3535 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
3536 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
3537 error logs.
3538
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003539 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02003540 logging.
3541
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003542
3543option logasap
3544no option logasap
3545 Enable or disable early logging of HTTP requests
3546 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3547 yes | yes | yes | no
3548 Arguments : none
3549
3550 By default, HTTP requests are logged upon termination so that the total
3551 transfer time and the number of bytes appear in the logs. When large objects
3552 are being transferred, it may take a while before the request appears in the
3553 logs. Using "option logasap", the request gets logged as soon as the server
3554 sends the complete headers. The only missing information in the logs will be
3555 the total number of bytes which will indicate everything except the amount
3556 of data transferred, and the total time which will not take the transfer
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003557 time into account. In such a situation, it's a good practice to capture the
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003558 "Content-Length" response header so that the logs at least indicate how many
3559 bytes are expected to be transferred.
3560
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003561 Examples :
3562 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
3563 mode http
3564 option httplog
3565 option logasap
3566 log 192.168.2.200 local3
3567
3568 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
3569 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
3570 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
3571 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
3572
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003573 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003574 logging.
3575
3576
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02003577option mysql-check [ user <username> ]
3578 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01003579 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3580 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02003581 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003582 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
3583 server.
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02003584
3585 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
3586 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
3587 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialisation packet and/or
3588 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
3589 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
3590 in the MySQL table, like this :
3591
3592 USE mysql;
3593 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
3594 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
3595
3596 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
3597 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialisation packet or
3598 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
3599 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
3600 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
3601 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
3602 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
3603 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
3604 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
3605
3606 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
3607 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01003608
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02003609 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01003610
3611 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
3612 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
3613 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
3614 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
3615 which requires the cttproxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL server
3616 to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
3617
3618 See also: "option httpchk"
3619
Rauf Kuliyev38b41562011-01-04 15:14:13 +01003620option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
3621 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
3622 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3623 yes | no | yes | yes
3624 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003625 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
3626 PostgreSQL server.
Rauf Kuliyev38b41562011-01-04 15:14:13 +01003627
3628 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
3629 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
3630 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
3631 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
3632
3633 See also: "option httpchk"
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01003634
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003635option nolinger
3636no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003637 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003638 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3639 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01003640 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003641
3642 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (eg: they are
3643 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
3644 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
3645 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
3646 connections.
3647
3648 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
3649 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
3650 the session is instantly purged from the system's tables. This usually has
3651 side effects such as increased number of TCP resets due to old retransmits
3652 getting immediately rejected. Some firewalls may sometimes complain about
3653 this too.
3654
3655 For this reason, it is not recommended to use this option when not absolutely
3656 needed. You know that you need it when you have thousands of FIN_WAIT1
3657 sessions on your system (TIME_WAIT ones do not count).
3658
3659 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
3660 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
3661 for servers.
3662
3663 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3664 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3665
3666
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003667option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
3668 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
3669 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3670 yes | yes | yes | yes
3671 Arguments :
3672 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
3673 matching <network>
3674 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
3675 header name.
3676
3677 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
3678 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
3679 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
3680 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
3681 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
3682 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
3683 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
3684 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
3685 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
3686 possible that the client has already brought one.
3687
3688 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
3689 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
3690 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
3691 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
3692 header and requires different one.
3693
3694 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
3695 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
3696 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
3697 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
3698 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
3699 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
3700 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
3701
3702 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
3703 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
3704 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
3705 both are defined.
3706
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003707 It is important to note that by default, HAProxy works in tunnel mode and
3708 only inspects the first request of a connection, meaning that only the first
3709 request will have the header appended, which is certainly not what you want.
3710 In order to fix this, ensure that any of the "httpclose", "forceclose" or
3711 "http-server-close" options is set when using this option.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003712
3713 Examples :
3714 # Original Destination address
3715 frontend www
3716 mode http
3717 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
3718
3719 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
3720 backend www
3721 mode http
3722 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
3723
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003724 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
3725 "option forceclose"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003726
3727
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003728option persist
3729no option persist
3730 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
3731 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3732 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01003733 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003734
3735 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
3736 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
3737 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
3738 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
3739 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
3740 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
3741 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
3742 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
3743 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
3744 redirected to another valid server.
3745
3746 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3747 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3748
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003749 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003750
3751
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01003752option redispatch
3753no option redispatch
3754 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
3755 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3756 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01003757 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01003758
3759 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
3760 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
3761 be able to access the service anymore.
3762
3763 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their
3764 persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
3765
3766 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
3767 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
3768 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003769
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01003770 This form is the preferred form, which replaces both the "redispatch" and
3771 "redisp" keywords.
3772
3773 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3774 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3775
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003776 See also : "redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01003777
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003778
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02003779option redis-check
3780 Use redis health checks for server testing
3781 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3782 yes | no | yes | yes
3783 Arguments : none
3784
3785 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
3786 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
3787 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
3788 find the "+PONG" response message.
3789
3790 Example :
3791 option redis-check
3792
3793 See also : "option httpchk"
3794
3795
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003796option smtpchk
3797option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
3798 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
3799 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3800 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003801 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003802 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
3803 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESTMP). All other
3804 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
3805
3806 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
3807 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
3808 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
3809
3810 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
3811 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
3812 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
3813 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
3814 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
3815 dead server.
3816
3817 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
3818 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
3819 so you may want to experiment to improve the behaviour. Using telnet on port
3820 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
3821
3822 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
3823 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
3824 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
3825 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
3826 which requires the cttproxy feature to be compiled in.
3827
3828 Example :
3829 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
3830
3831 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
3832
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01003833
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02003834option socket-stats
3835no option socket-stats
3836
3837 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
3838 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3839 yes | yes | yes | no
3840
3841 Arguments : none
3842
3843
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01003844option splice-auto
3845no option splice-auto
3846 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
3847 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3848 yes | yes | yes | yes
3849 Arguments : none
3850
3851 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
3852 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
3853 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. Haproxy
3854 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003855 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01003856 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
3857 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
3858 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
3859 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
3860
3861 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
3862 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
3863 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
3864 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
3865 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
3866 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
3867 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
3868 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
3869 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
3870 keyword.
3871
3872 Example :
3873 option splice-auto
3874
3875 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3876 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3877
3878 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
3879 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
3880
3881
3882option splice-request
3883no option splice-request
3884 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
3885 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3886 yes | yes | yes | yes
3887 Arguments : none
3888
3889 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003890 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01003891 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
3892 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
3893 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
3894 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
3895
3896 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
3897
3898 Example :
3899 option splice-request
3900
3901 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3902 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3903
3904 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
3905 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
3906
3907
3908option splice-response
3909no option splice-response
3910 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
3911 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3912 yes | yes | yes | yes
3913 Arguments : none
3914
3915 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003916 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01003917 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
3918 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
3919 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
3920 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
3921
3922 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
3923
3924 Example :
3925 option splice-response
3926
3927 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3928 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3929
3930 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
3931 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
3932
3933
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003934option srvtcpka
3935no option srvtcpka
3936 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
3937 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3938 yes | no | yes | yes
3939 Arguments : none
3940
3941 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
3942 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
3943 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
3944 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
3945
3946 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
3947 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
3948 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
3949 operating system and its tuning parameters.
3950
3951 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
3952 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
3953 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
3954 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
3955 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
3956
3957 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
3958
3959 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
3960 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
3961 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
3962
3963 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3964 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3965
3966 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
3967
3968
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003969option ssl-hello-chk
3970 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
3971 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3972 yes | no | yes | yes
3973 Arguments : none
3974
3975 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
3976 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
3977 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
3978 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
3979 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
3980 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
3981 hello message.
3982
3983 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
3984 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
3985 messages, which is appreciable.
3986
3987 See also: "option httpchk"
3988
3989
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02003990option tcp-smart-accept
3991no option tcp-smart-accept
3992 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
3993 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3994 yes | yes | yes | no
3995 Arguments : none
3996
3997 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
3998 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
3999 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
4000 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
4001 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
4002 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
4003
4004 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
4005 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
4006 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
4007 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
4008
4009 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
4010 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
4011 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
4012 fall back to normal behaviour by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
4013
4014 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
4015 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
4016 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
4017
4018 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
4019 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
4020 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
4021
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02004022 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
4023
4024
4025option tcp-smart-connect
4026no option tcp-smart-connect
4027 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
4028 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4029 yes | no | yes | yes
4030 Arguments : none
4031
4032 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
4033 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
4034 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
4035 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
4036 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
4037
4038 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
4039 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
4040 complex.
4041
4042 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
4043 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
4044 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
4045
4046 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4047 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4048
4049 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
4050
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02004051
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004052option tcpka
4053 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
4054 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4055 yes | yes | yes | yes
4056 Arguments : none
4057
4058 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
4059 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
4060 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
4061 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
4062
4063 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
4064 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
4065 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
4066 operating system and its tuning parameters.
4067
4068 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
4069 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
4070 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
4071 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
4072 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
4073
4074 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
4075
4076 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
4077 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
4078 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
4079 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
4080 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
4081 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
4082 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
4083 backends.
4084
4085 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
4086
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004087
4088option tcplog
4089 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
4090 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4091 yes | yes | yes | yes
4092 Arguments : none
4093
4094 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
4095 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
4096 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
4097 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
4098 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
4099 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
4100 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
4101 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
4102
4103 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
4104
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004105 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004106
4107
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004108option transparent
4109no option transparent
4110 Enable client-side transparent proxying
4111 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01004112 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004113 Arguments : none
4114
4115 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
4116 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
4117 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
4118 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
4119 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
4120 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
4121 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
4122 appropriate server.
4123
4124 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
4125 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
4126
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01004127 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004128 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004129
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004130
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004131persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02004132persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004133 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
4134 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4135 yes | no | yes | yes
4136 Arguments :
4137 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02004138 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
4139 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004140
4141 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
4142 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
4143 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analysed
4144 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
4145 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
4146 forwarded to this server.
4147
4148 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
4149 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
4150 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004151 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004152 a single "listen" section.
4153
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02004154 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
4155 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
4156 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
4157
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004158 Example :
4159 listen tse-farm
4160 bind :3389
4161 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
4162 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
4163 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
4164 # apply RDP cookie persistence
4165 persist rdp-cookie
4166 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02004167 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004168 balance rdp-cookie
4169 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
4170 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
4171
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09004172 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
4173 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004174
4175
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01004176rate-limit sessions <rate>
4177 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
4178 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4179 yes | yes | yes | no
4180 Arguments :
4181 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
4182 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
4183
4184 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
4185 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
4186 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
4187 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
4188 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
4189 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
4190
4191 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
4192 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
4193 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
4194 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
4195
4196 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
4197 listen smtp
4198 mode tcp
4199 bind :25
4200 rate-limit sessions 10
4201 server 127.0.0.1:1025
4202
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02004203 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
4204 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
4205 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01004206
4207 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
4208
4209
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02004210redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
4211redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
4212redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02004213 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
4214 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4215 no | yes | yes | yes
4216
4217 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01004218 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02004219
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004220 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02004221 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
4222 the HTTP "Location" header.
4223
4224 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
4225 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
4226 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
4227 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
4228 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
4229 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie).
4230
4231 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
4232 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
4233 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
4234 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
4235 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
4236 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
4237 returned, which most recent browsers interprete as redirecting to
4238 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
4239 HTTPS.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004240
4241 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
4242 is desired. Only codes 301, 302 and 303 are supported, and 302 is
4243 used if no code is specified. 301 means "Moved permanently", and
4244 a browser may cache the Location. 302 means "Moved permanently"
4245 and means that the browser should not cache the redirection. 303
4246 is equivalent to 302 except that the browser will fetch the
4247 location with a GET method.
4248
4249 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
4250 expected behaviour of a redirection :
4251
4252 - "drop-query"
4253 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
4254 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
4255 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
4256 with a location-type redirect.
4257
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01004258 - "append-slash"
4259 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
4260 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
4261 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
4262 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
4263
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004264 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
4265 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
4266 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
4267 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
4268 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
4269 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
4270 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
4271
4272 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
4273 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
4274 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
4275 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
4276 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
4277 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
4278 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02004279
4280 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
4281 acl clear dst_port 80
4282 acl secure dst_port 8080
4283 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004284 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01004285 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004286 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
4287
4288 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01004289 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
4290 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
4291 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004292 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02004293
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01004294 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
4295 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
4296 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
4297
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02004298 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by haproxy.
4299 redirect scheme https if !{ is_ssl }
4300
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004301 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02004302
4303
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004304redisp (deprecated)
4305redispatch (deprecated)
4306 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
4307 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4308 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004309 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004310
4311 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
4312 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
4313 be able to access the service anymore.
4314
4315 Specifying "redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their persistence and
4316 redistribute them to a working server.
4317
4318 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
4319 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
4320 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004321
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004322 This form is deprecated, do not use it in any new configuration, use the new
4323 "option redispatch" instead.
4324
4325 See also : "option redispatch"
4326
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004327
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01004328reqadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004329 Add a header at the end of the HTTP request
4330 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4331 no | yes | yes | yes
4332 Arguments :
4333 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
4334 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004335 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004336
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01004337 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4338 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4339
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004340 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
4341 the last header of an HTTP request.
4342
4343 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4344 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4345 responses.
4346
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01004347 Example : add "X-Proto: SSL" to requests coming via port 81
4348 acl is-ssl dst_port 81
4349 reqadd X-Proto:\ SSL if is-ssl
4350
4351 See also: "rspadd", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7
4352 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004353
4354
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004355reqallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4356reqiallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004357 Definitely allow an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
4358 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4359 no | yes | yes | yes
4360 Arguments :
4361 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4362 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4363 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4364 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4365 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
4366 "reqallow" keyword strictly matches case while "reqiallow"
4367 ignores case.
4368
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004369 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4370 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4371
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004372 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
4373 <search> will mark the request as allowed, even if any later test would
4374 result in a deny. The test applies both to the request line and to request
4375 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004376 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004377
4378 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
4379 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
4380
4381 Example :
4382 # allow www.* but refuse *.local
4383 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
4384 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
4385
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004386 See also: "reqdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and
4387 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004388
4389
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004390reqdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4391reqidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004392 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP request
4393 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4394 no | yes | yes | yes
4395 Arguments :
4396 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4397 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4398 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4399 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4400 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqdel"
4401 keyword strictly matches case while "reqidel" ignores case.
4402
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004403 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4404 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4405
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004406 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request
4407 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
4408 and/or dangerous headers or cookies from a request before passing it to the
4409 next servers.
4410
4411 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4412 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4413 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
4414
4415 Example :
4416 # remove X-Forwarded-For header and SERVER cookie
4417 reqidel ^X-Forwarded-For:.*
4418 reqidel ^Cookie:.*SERVER=
4419
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004420 See also: "reqadd", "reqrep", "rspdel", section 6 about HTTP header
4421 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004422
4423
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004424reqdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4425reqideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004426 Deny an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
4427 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4428 no | yes | yes | yes
4429 Arguments :
4430 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4431 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4432 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4433 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4434 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
4435 "reqdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "reqideny" ignores
4436 case.
4437
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004438 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4439 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4440
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004441 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
4442 <search> will mark the request as denied, even if any later test would
4443 result in an allow. The test applies both to the request line and to request
4444 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004445 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004446
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01004447 A denied request will generate an "HTTP 403 forbidden" response once the
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004448 complete request has been parsed. This is consistent with what is practiced
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004449 using ACLs.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01004450
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004451 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
4452 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
4453
4454 Example :
4455 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*
4456 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
4457 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
4458
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004459 See also: "reqallow", "rspdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header
4460 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004461
4462
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004463reqpass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4464reqipass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004465 Ignore any HTTP request line matching a regular expression in next rules
4466 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4467 no | yes | yes | yes
4468 Arguments :
4469 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4470 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4471 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4472 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4473 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
4474 "reqpass" keyword strictly matches case while "reqipass" ignores
4475 case.
4476
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004477 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4478 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4479
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004480 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
4481 <search> will skip next rules, without assigning any deny or allow verdict.
4482 The test applies both to the request line and to request headers. Keep in
4483 mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
4484
4485 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
4486 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
4487
4488 Example :
4489 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*, but ignore "www.private.local"
4490 reqipass ^Host:\ www.private\.local
4491 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
4492 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
4493
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004494 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header
4495 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004496
4497
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004498reqrep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4499reqirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004500 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP request line
4501 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4502 no | yes | yes | yes
4503 Arguments :
4504 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4505 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4506 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4507 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4508 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqrep"
4509 keyword strictly matches case while "reqirep" ignores case.
4510
4511 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
4512 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
4513 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
4514 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004515 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004516
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004517 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4518 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4519
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004520 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request (both
4521 the request line and header lines) will be completely replaced with <string>.
4522 Most common use of this is to rewrite URLs or domain names in "Host" headers.
4523
4524 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4525 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4526 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
4527 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that URLs in
4528 request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
4529
4530 Example :
4531 # replace "/static/" with "/" at the beginning of any request path.
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04004532 reqrep ^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*) \1\ /\2
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004533 # replace "www.mydomain.com" with "www" in the host name.
4534 reqirep ^Host:\ www.mydomain.com Host:\ www
4535
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004536 See also: "reqadd", "reqdel", "rsprep", section 6 about HTTP header
4537 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004538
4539
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004540reqtarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4541reqitarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004542 Tarpit an HTTP request containing a line matching a regular expression
4543 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4544 no | yes | yes | yes
4545 Arguments :
4546 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4547 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4548 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4549 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4550 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
4551 "reqtarpit" keyword strictly matches case while "reqitarpit"
4552 ignores case.
4553
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004554 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4555 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4556
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004557 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
4558 <search> will be tarpitted, which means that it will connect to nowhere, will
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01004559 be kept open for a pre-defined time, then will return an HTTP error 500 so
4560 that the attacker does not suspect it has been tarpitted. The status 500 will
4561 be reported in the logs, but the completion flags will indicate "PT". The
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004562 delay is defined by "timeout tarpit", or "timeout connect" if the former is
4563 not set.
4564
4565 The goal of the tarpit is to slow down robots attacking servers with
4566 identifiable requests. Many robots limit their outgoing number of connections
4567 and stay connected waiting for a reply which can take several minutes to
4568 come. Depending on the environment and attack, it may be particularly
4569 efficient at reducing the load on the network and firewalls.
4570
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004571 Examples :
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004572 # ignore user-agents reporting any flavour of "Mozilla" or "MSIE", but
4573 # block all others.
4574 reqipass ^User-Agent:\.*(Mozilla|MSIE)
4575 reqitarpit ^User-Agent:
4576
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004577 # block bad guys
4578 acl badguys src 10.1.0.3 172.16.13.20/28
4579 reqitarpit . if badguys
4580
4581 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "reqpass", section 6 about HTTP header
4582 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004583
4584
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02004585retries <value>
4586 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
4587 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4588 yes | no | yes | yes
4589 Arguments :
4590 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
4591 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
4592 default value is 3.
4593
4594 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
4595 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
4596 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
4597
4598 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
4599 a turn-around timer of 1 second is applied before a retry occurs.
4600
4601 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
4602 server even if a cookie references a different server.
4603
4604 See also : "option redispatch"
4605
4606
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004607rspadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004608 Add a header at the end of the HTTP response
4609 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4610 no | yes | yes | yes
4611 Arguments :
4612 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
4613 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004614 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004615
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004616 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4617 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4618
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004619 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
4620 the last header of an HTTP response.
4621
4622 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4623 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4624 responses.
4625
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004626 See also: "reqadd", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7
4627 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004628
4629
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004630rspdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4631rspidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004632 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP response
4633 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4634 no | yes | yes | yes
4635 Arguments :
4636 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4637 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
4638 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
4639 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
4640 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
4641 The "rspdel" keyword strictly matches case while "rspidel"
4642 ignores case.
4643
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004644 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4645 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4646
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004647 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response
4648 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02004649 and/or sensitive headers or cookies from a response before passing it to the
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004650 client.
4651
4652 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4653 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4654 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
4655
4656 Example :
4657 # remove the Server header from responses
4658 reqidel ^Server:.*
4659
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004660 See also: "rspadd", "rsprep", "reqdel", section 6 about HTTP header
4661 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004662
4663
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004664rspdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4665rspideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004666 Block an HTTP response if a line matches a regular expression
4667 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4668 no | yes | yes | yes
4669 Arguments :
4670 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4671 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
4672 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
4673 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
4674 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
4675 The "rspdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "rspideny"
4676 ignores case.
4677
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004678 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4679 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4680
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004681 A response containing any line which matches extended regular expression
4682 <search> will mark the request as denied. The test applies both to the
4683 response line and to response headers. Keep in mind that header names are not
4684 case-sensitive.
4685
4686 Main use of this keyword is to prevent sensitive information leak and to
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01004687 block the response before it reaches the client. If a response is denied, it
4688 will be replaced with an HTTP 502 error so that the client never retrieves
4689 any sensitive data.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004690
4691 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
4692 Rspdeny should be avoided in new designs.
4693
4694 Example :
4695 # Ensure that no content type matching ms-word will leak
4696 rspideny ^Content-type:\.*/ms-word
4697
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004698 See also: "reqdeny", "acl", "block", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation
4699 and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004700
4701
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004702rsprep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4703rspirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004704 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP response line
4705 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4706 no | yes | yes | yes
4707 Arguments :
4708 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4709 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
4710 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
4711 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
4712 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
4713 The "rsprep" keyword strictly matches case while "rspirep"
4714 ignores case.
4715
4716 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
4717 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
4718 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
4719 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004720 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004721
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004722 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4723 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4724
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004725 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response (both
4726 the response line and header lines) will be completely replaced with
4727 <string>. Most common use of this is to rewrite Location headers.
4728
4729 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4730 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4731 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
4732 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that header names
4733 are not case-sensitive.
4734
4735 Example :
4736 # replace "Location: 127.0.0.1:8080" with "Location: www.mydomain.com"
4737 rspirep ^Location:\ 127.0.0.1:8080 Location:\ www.mydomain.com
4738
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004739 See also: "rspadd", "rspdel", "reqrep", section 6 about HTTP header
4740 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004741
4742
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01004743server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004744 Declare a server in a backend
4745 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4746 no | no | yes | yes
4747 Arguments :
4748 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05004749 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-server-name" is
4750 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004751
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01004752 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
4753 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
4754 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
4755 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +02004756 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
4757 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
4758 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
4759 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
4760 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
4761 to report statistics.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004762
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02004763 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004764 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
4765 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
4766 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
4767 adding this value to the client's port.
4768
4769 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
4770 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004771 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004772
4773 Examples :
4774 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
4775 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
4776
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05004777 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
4778 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004779
4780
4781source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02004782source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01004783source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004784 Set the source address for outgoing connections
4785 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4786 yes | no | yes | yes
4787 Arguments :
4788 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
4789 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
4790 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
4791 the most appropriate address to reach its destination.
4792
4793 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
4794 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02004795 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
4796 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
4797 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004798
4799 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
4800 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
4801 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
4802 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
4803 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
4804 <addr>.
4805
4806 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
4807 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
4808 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
4809 port.
4810
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02004811 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
4812 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
4813 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
4814 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
4815 and to automatically bind to the the client's IP address as seen
4816 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
4817 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
4818 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
4819 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
4820 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
4821 HTTP header.
4822
4823 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
4824 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004825 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02004826 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
4827 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
4828 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
4829 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
4830 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
4831 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
4832 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
4833
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01004834 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
4835 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
4836 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
4837 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
4838 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
4839 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
4840
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004841 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
4842 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
4843 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
4844 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
4845
4846 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
4847 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
4848 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
4849 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
4850 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
4851 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
4852
4853 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
4854 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
4855 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
4856 there are two methods :
4857
4858 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
4859 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
4860 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
4861 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
4862 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
4863 of the client ranges may be used.
4864
4865 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
4866 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
4867 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
4868 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
4869 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
4870 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
4871 same session.
4872
4873 Note that depending on the transparent proxy technology used, it may be
4874 required to force the source address. In fact, cttproxy version 2 requires an
4875 IP address in <addr> above, and does not support setting of "0.0.0.0" as the
4876 IP address because it creates NAT entries which much match the exact outgoing
4877 address. Tproxy version 4 and some other kernel patches which work in pure
4878 forwarding mode generally will not have this limitation.
4879
4880 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
4881 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
4882 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004883 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004884
4885 Examples :
4886 backend private
4887 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
4888 source 192.168.1.200
4889
4890 backend transparent_ssl1
4891 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
4892 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
4893
4894 backend transparent_ssl2
4895 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
4896 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
4897 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
4898
4899 backend transparent_ssl3
4900 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
4901 # is more conntrack-friendly.
4902 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
4903
4904 backend transparent_smtp
4905 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
4906 # with Tproxy version 4.
4907 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
4908
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02004909 backend transparent_http
4910 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
4911 # proxy.
4912 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
4913
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004914 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004915 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
4916
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004917
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004918srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
4919 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
4920 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4921 yes | no | yes | yes
4922 Arguments :
4923 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
4924 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
4925 as explained at the top of this document.
4926
4927 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
4928 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
4929 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
4930 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
4931 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
4932 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
4933 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
4934
4935 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
4936 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
4937 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
4938 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
4939 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004940 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004941 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004942 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004943
4944 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
4945 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
4946 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
4947 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
4948 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
4949 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
4950
4951 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
4952 Please use "timeout server" instead.
4953
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02004954 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout client" and
4955 "clitimeout".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004956
4957
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02004958stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
4959 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
4960 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4961 no | no | yes | yes
4962
4963 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
4964 matched.
4965
4966 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
4967 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
4968
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01004969 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
4970 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
4971 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
4972
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +01004973 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
4974 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
4975 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
4976 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02004977
4978 Example :
4979 # statistics admin level only for localhost
4980 backend stats_localhost
4981 stats enable
4982 stats admin if LOCALHOST
4983
4984 Example :
4985 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
4986 backend stats_auth
4987 stats enable
4988 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
4989 stats admin if TRUE
4990
4991 Example :
4992 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
4993 userlist stats-auth
4994 group admin users admin
4995 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
4996 group readonly users haproxy
4997 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
4998
4999 backend stats_auth
5000 stats enable
5001 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
5002 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
5003 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
5004 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
5005
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005006 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
5007 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
5008 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02005009
5010
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005011stats auth <user>:<passwd>
5012 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
5013 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5014 yes | no | yes | yes
5015 Arguments :
5016 <user> is a user name to grant access to
5017
5018 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
5019
5020 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
5021 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
5022 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
5023 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
5024 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
5025 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
5026
5027 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
5028 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
5029 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02005030 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005031
5032 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
5033 report using "stats scope".
5034
5035 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5036 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5037 unobvious parameters.
5038
5039 Example :
5040 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5041 backend public_www
5042 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5043 stats enable
5044 stats hide-version
5045 stats scope .
5046 stats uri /admin?stats
5047 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5048 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5049 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5050
5051 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5052 backend private_monitoring
5053 stats enable
5054 stats uri /admin?stats
5055 stats refresh 5s
5056
5057 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
5058
5059
5060stats enable
5061 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
5062 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5063 yes | no | yes | yes
5064 Arguments : none
5065
5066 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
5067 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
5068 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
5069 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
5070 - stats auth : no authentication
5071 - stats scope : no restriction
5072
5073 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5074 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5075 unobvious parameters.
5076
5077 Example :
5078 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5079 backend public_www
5080 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5081 stats enable
5082 stats hide-version
5083 stats scope .
5084 stats uri /admin?stats
5085 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5086 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5087 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5088
5089 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5090 backend private_monitoring
5091 stats enable
5092 stats uri /admin?stats
5093 stats refresh 5s
5094
5095 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
5096
5097
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005098stats hide-version
5099 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005100 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5101 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005102 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005103
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005104 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
5105 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
5106 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
5107 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
5108 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
5109 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005110
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02005111 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5112 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5113 unobvious parameters.
5114
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005115 Example :
5116 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5117 backend public_www
5118 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02005119 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005120 stats hide-version
5121 stats scope .
5122 stats uri /admin?stats
5123 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5124 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5125 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005126
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005127 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5128 backend private_monitoring
5129 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005130 stats uri /admin?stats
5131 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +01005132
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005133 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005134
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01005135
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02005136stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
5137 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5138 Access control for statistics
5139
5140 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5141 no | no | yes | yes
5142
5143 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
5144 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
5145 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
5146 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
5147 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
5148 should be asked to enter a username and password.
5149
5150 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
5151 instance.
5152
5153 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
5154 about ACL usage.
5155
5156
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005157stats realm <realm>
5158 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
5159 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5160 yes | no | yes | yes
5161 Arguments :
5162 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
5163 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
5164 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
5165
5166 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
5167 using a backslash ('\').
5168
5169 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
5170 only related to authentication.
5171
5172 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5173 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5174 unobvious parameters.
5175
5176 Example :
5177 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5178 backend public_www
5179 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5180 stats enable
5181 stats hide-version
5182 stats scope .
5183 stats uri /admin?stats
5184 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5185 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5186 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5187
5188 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5189 backend private_monitoring
5190 stats enable
5191 stats uri /admin?stats
5192 stats refresh 5s
5193
5194 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
5195
5196
5197stats refresh <delay>
5198 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
5199 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5200 yes | no | yes | yes
5201 Arguments :
5202 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
5203 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
5204 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
5205 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
5206 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
5207 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
5208
5209 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
5210 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
5211 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
5212 he wants automatic refresh of the page or not.
5213
5214 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5215 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5216 unobvious parameters.
5217
5218 Example :
5219 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5220 backend public_www
5221 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5222 stats enable
5223 stats hide-version
5224 stats scope .
5225 stats uri /admin?stats
5226 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5227 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5228 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5229
5230 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5231 backend private_monitoring
5232 stats enable
5233 stats uri /admin?stats
5234 stats refresh 5s
5235
5236 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
5237
5238
5239stats scope { <name> | "." }
5240 Enable statistics and limit access scope
5241 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5242 yes | no | yes | yes
5243 Arguments :
5244 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
5245 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
5246 section in which the statement appears.
5247
5248 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
5249 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
5250 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
5251 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
5252 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
5253 exists.
5254
5255 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5256 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5257 unobvious parameters.
5258
5259 Example :
5260 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5261 backend public_www
5262 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5263 stats enable
5264 stats hide-version
5265 stats scope .
5266 stats uri /admin?stats
5267 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5268 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5269 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5270
5271 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5272 backend private_monitoring
5273 stats enable
5274 stats uri /admin?stats
5275 stats refresh 5s
5276
5277 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
5278
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005279
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02005280stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005281 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
5282 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5283 yes | no | yes | yes
5284
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02005285 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005286 description from global section is automatically used instead.
5287
5288 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
5289 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
5290
5291 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5292 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04005293 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005294
5295 Example :
5296 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5297 backend private_monitoring
5298 stats enable
5299 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
5300 stats uri /admin?stats
5301 stats refresh 5s
5302
5303 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
5304 global section.
5305
5306
5307stats show-legends
5308 Enable reporting additional informations on the statistics page :
5309 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
5310 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
5311 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
5312 - IP (socket, server)
5313 - cookie (backend, server)
5314
5315 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5316 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04005317 unobvious parameters. Default behaviour is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005318
5319 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
5320
5321
5322stats show-node [ <name> ]
5323 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
5324 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5325 yes | no | yes | yes
5326 Arguments:
5327 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
5328 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
5329
5330 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
5331 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04005332 provided for each customer. Default behaviour is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005333
5334 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5335 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5336 unobvious parameters.
5337
5338 Example:
5339 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5340 backend private_monitoring
5341 stats enable
5342 stats show-node Europe-1
5343 stats uri /admin?stats
5344 stats refresh 5s
5345
5346 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
5347 section.
5348
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005349
5350stats uri <prefix>
5351 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
5352 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5353 yes | no | yes | yes
5354 Arguments :
5355 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
5356 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
5357 query string.
5358
5359 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
5360 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
5361 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
5362 possible to reach it in the application.
5363
5364 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005365 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005366 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
5367 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
5368 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
5369 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
5370
5371 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
5372 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
5373 an address or a port to statistics only.
5374
5375 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5376 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5377 unobvious parameters.
5378
5379 Example :
5380 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5381 backend public_www
5382 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5383 stats enable
5384 stats hide-version
5385 stats scope .
5386 stats uri /admin?stats
5387 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5388 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5389 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5390
5391 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5392 backend private_monitoring
5393 stats enable
5394 stats uri /admin?stats
5395 stats refresh 5s
5396
5397 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
5398
5399
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005400stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
5401 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005402 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005403 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005404
5405 Arguments :
5406 <pattern> is a pattern extraction rule as described in section 7.8. It
5407 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
5408 will be analysed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
5409 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
5410
5411 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
5412 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
5413 the "stick-table" statement.
5414
5415 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
5416 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
5417 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
5418 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
5419 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
5420
5421 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
5422 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
5423 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
5424 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
5425 transformation rules.
5426
5427 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
5428 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
5429 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
5430 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
5431 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
5432 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
5433 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
5434
5435 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
5436 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
5437 ACL based conditions.
5438
5439 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
5440 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
5441 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
5442 matches can be used as fallbacks.
5443
5444 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
5445 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
5446 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
5447 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
5448
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005449 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
5450 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
5451 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
5452
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005453 Example :
5454 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
5455 # last 30 minutes
5456 backend pop
5457 mode tcp
5458 balance roundrobin
5459 stick store-request src
5460 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
5461 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
5462 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
5463
5464 backend smtp
5465 mode tcp
5466 balance roundrobin
5467 stick match src table pop
5468 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
5469 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
5470
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005471 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
5472 about ACLs and pattern extraction.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005473
5474
5475stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
5476 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
5477 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5478 no | no | yes | yes
5479
5480 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
5481 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
5482 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
5483 for writing more maintainable configurations.
5484
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005485 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
5486 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
5487 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
5488
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005489 Examples :
5490 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +01005491 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005492
5493 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
5494 stick match src table pop if !localhost
5495 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
5496
5497
5498 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
5499 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
5500 backend http
5501 mode http
5502 balance roundrobin
5503 stick on src table https
5504 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
5505 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
5506 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
5507
5508 backend https
5509 mode tcp
5510 balance roundrobin
5511 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
5512 stick on src
5513 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
5514 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
5515
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005516 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005517
5518
5519stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
5520 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
5521 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5522 no | no | yes | yes
5523
5524 Arguments :
5525 <pattern> is a pattern extraction rule as described in section 7.8. It
5526 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
5527 will be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
5528 server is selected.
5529
5530 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
5531 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
5532 the "stick-table" statement.
5533
5534 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
5535 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
5536 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
5537 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
5538 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
5539 address.
5540
5541 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
5542 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
5543 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
5544 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
5545 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
5546 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
5547 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
5548 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
5549 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
5550 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
5551
5552 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
5553 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
5554 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
5555 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
5556 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
5557 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
5558 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
5559
5560 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
5561 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
5562 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
5563 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
5564
5565 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
5566 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
5567 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
5568 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
5569 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
5570 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
5571 another protocol or access method.
5572
5573 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
5574 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
5575 the request.
5576
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005577 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
5578 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
5579 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
5580
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005581 Example :
5582 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
5583 # last 30 minutes
5584 backend pop
5585 mode tcp
5586 balance roundrobin
5587 stick store-request src
5588 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
5589 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
5590 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
5591
5592 backend smtp
5593 mode tcp
5594 balance roundrobin
5595 stick match src table pop
5596 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
5597 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
5598
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005599 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
5600 about ACLs and pattern extraction.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005601
5602
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02005603stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02005604 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>]
5605 [store <data_type>]*
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005606 Configure the stickiness table for the current backend
5607 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02005608 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005609
5610 Arguments :
5611 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
5612 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
5613 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
5614 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
5615
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01005616 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
5617 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
5618 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
5619 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
5620
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005621 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
5622 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
5623 instance.
5624
5625 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
5626 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
5627 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
5628 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
5629 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
5630 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02005631 to 32 characters.
5632
5633 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
5634 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
5635 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
5636 being stored. If the block provided by the pattern extractor
5637 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
5638 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005639
5640 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02005641 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
5642 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005643 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
5644 increase.
5645
5646 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01005647 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
5648 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
5649 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005650
5651 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
5652 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
5653 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
5654 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
5655 most often the desired behaviour. In some specific cases, it
5656 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
5657 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
5658 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
5659 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
5660 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
5661 parameter (see below).
5662
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02005663 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
5664 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
5665 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
5666 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
5667 soft restart.
5668
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005669 NOTE : peers can't be used in multi-process mode.
5670
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005671 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
5672 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
5673 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
5674 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
5675 section 2.2 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02005676 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005677 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
5678 if not expiration delay is specified.
5679
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02005680 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
5681 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
5682 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
5683 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02005684 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
5685 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
5686 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
5687 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
5688 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
5689 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
5690 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
5691 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
5692 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
5693 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
5694 types and their arguments.
5695
5696 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
5697 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
5698 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
5699 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
5700
5701 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
5702 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
5703 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
5704 specific behaviour was detected and must be known for future matches.
5705
5706 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
5707 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
5708 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
5709 they were received.
5710
5711 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
5712 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
5713 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
5714 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
5715 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
5716
5717 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
5718 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
5719 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
5720 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
5721 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
5722
5723 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
5724 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
5725 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
5726
5727 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
5728 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
5729 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
5730 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
5731 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
5732
5733 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
5734 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
5735 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
5736 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
5737 the client side.
5738
5739 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
5740 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
5741 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
5742 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
5743 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
5744 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
5745 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
5746
5747 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
5748 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
5749 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
5750 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
5751 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
5752 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
5753 (eg: vulnerability scan).
5754
5755 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
5756 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
5757 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
5758 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
5759 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
5760 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
5761
5762 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
5763 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes received from clients
5764 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
5765 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
5766
5767 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
5768 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
5769 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
5770 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
5771 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
5772 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
5773 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
5774 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
5775 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
5776 recommended for better fairness.
5777
5778 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
5779 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes sent to clients which
5780 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
5781 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
5782
5783 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
5784 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
5785 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
5786 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
5787 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
5788 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
5789 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
5790 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
5791 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
5792 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02005793
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02005794 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
5795 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005796 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
5797 reference it.
5798
5799 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
5800 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
5801 lost upon restart. In general it can be good as a complement but not always
5802 as an exclusive stickiness.
5803
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02005804 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
5805 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
5806 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
5807 something that can be ignored.
5808
5809 Example:
5810 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
5811 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
5812 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
5813 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
5814
5815 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.2
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +01005816 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005817
5818
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02005819stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
5820 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
5821 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5822 no | no | yes | yes
5823
5824 Arguments :
5825 <pattern> is a pattern extraction rule as described in section 7.8. It
5826 describes what elements of the response or connection will
5827 be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
5828 server is selected.
5829
5830 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
5831 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
5832 the "stick-table" statement.
5833
5834 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
5835 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
5836 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
5837 when the response is a SSL server hello.
5838
5839 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
5840 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
5841 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
5842 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
5843 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
5844 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005845 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02005846 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
5847 rules.
5848
5849 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
5850 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
5851 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
5852 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
5853 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
5854 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
5855 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
5856
5857 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
5858 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
5859 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
5860 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
5861
5862 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
5863 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
5864 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
5865 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
5866 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
5867 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
5868 another protocol or access method.
5869
5870 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
5871
5872 Example :
5873 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
5874 backend https
5875 mode tcp
5876 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02005877 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02005878 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005879
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02005880 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
5881 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
5882
5883 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
5884 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
5885 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
5886
5887 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
5888 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005889
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02005890 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
5891 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
5892 # at offset 44.
5893
5894 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
5895 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
5896
5897 # Learn on response if server hello.
5898 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02005899
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02005900 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
5901 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
5902
5903 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
5904 extraction.
5905
5906
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005907tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
5908 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02005909 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5910 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005911 Arguments :
5912 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
5913 actions include : "accept", "reject", "track-sc1", "track-sc2".
5914 See below for more details.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02005915
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005916 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005917
5918 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
5919 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005920 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
5921 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
5922 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
5923 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
5924 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
5925 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005926
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005927 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
5928 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
5929 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
5930 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005931
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005932 Three types of actions are supported :
5933 - accept :
5934 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
5935 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
5936 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005937
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005938 - reject :
5939 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
5940 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
5941 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
5942 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
5943 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
5944 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
5945 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
5946 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
5947 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
5948 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
5949 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
5950 be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005951
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005952 - { track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
5953 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
5954 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. Two sets
5955 of counters may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection. The
5956 first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
5957 specified table as the first set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed
5958 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the second
5959 set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of counters for
5960 the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend ones.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005961
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005962 These actions take one or two arguments :
5963 <key> is mandatory, and defines the criterion the tracking key will
5964 be derived from. At the moment, only "src" is supported. With
5965 it, the key will be the connection's source IPv4 address.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005966
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005967 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
5968 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
5969 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
5970 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005971
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005972 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
5973 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
5974 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
5975 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
5976 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
5977 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
5978 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
5979 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
5980 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
5981 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005982
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005983 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
5984 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
5985 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005986
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005987 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
5988 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
5989 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005990
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005991 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005992 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005993 tcp-request connection track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005994
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005995 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
5996 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
5997 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005998
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005999 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
6000 tcp-request connection track-sc1 src
6001 tcp-request connection reject if { sc1_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006002
6003 See section 7 about ACL usage.
6004
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006005 See also : "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006006
6007
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006008tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
6009 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006010 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02006011 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006012 Arguments :
6013 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
6014 actions include : "accept", "reject", "track-sc1", "track-sc2".
6015 See "tcp-request connection" above for their signification.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006016
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006017 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006018
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006019 A request's contents can be analysed at an early stage of request processing
6020 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
6021 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
6022 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or the TCP request inspection delay
6023 expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006024
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006025 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
6026 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
6027 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
6028 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
6029 both frontends and backends. In frontends, they will be evaluated upon new
6030 connections. In backends, they will be evaluated once a session is assigned
6031 a backend. This means that a single frontend connection may be evaluated
6032 several times by one or multiple backends when a session gets reassigned
6033 (for instance after a client-side HTTP keep-alive request).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006034
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006035 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
6036 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
6037 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
6038 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006039
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006040 Three types of actions are supported :
6041 - accept :
6042 - reject :
6043 - { track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006044
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006045 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
6046 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006047
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006048 Also, it is worth noting that if sticky counters are tracked from a rule
6049 defined in a backend, this tracking will automatically end when the session
6050 releases the backend. That allows per-backend counter tracking even in case
6051 of HTTP keep-alive requests when the backend changes. While there is nothing
6052 mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the track-sc1 pointer to track
6053 per-frontend counters and track-sc2 to track per-backend counters.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006054
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006055 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006056 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
6057 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006058
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006059 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02006060 rules, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to preliminarily parse the
6061 contents of a buffer before extracting the required data. If the buffered
6062 contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the ACL does not match.
6063 The parser which is involved there is exactly the same as for all other HTTP
6064 processing, so there is no risk of parsing something differently.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006065
6066 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006067 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
6068 # and reject everything else.
6069 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
6070 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02006071 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006072 tcp-request content reject
6073
6074 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006075 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
6076 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
6077 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006078 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006079
6080 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
6081 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
6082 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006083 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006084 tcp-request content reject
6085
6086 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
6087 frontend when the backend detects abuse.
6088
6089 frontend http
6090 # Use General Purpose Couter 0 in SC1 as a global abuse counter
6091 # protecting all our sites
6092 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
6093 tcp-request connection track-sc1 src
6094 tcp-request connection reject if { sc1_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
6095 ...
6096 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
6097
6098 backend http_dynamic
6099 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
6100 # by SC2), block it globally in the frontend.
6101 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
6102 acl click_too_fast sc2_http_req_rate gt 10
6103 acl mark_as_abuser sc1_inc_gpc0
6104 tcp-request content track-sc2 src
6105 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006106
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006107 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006108
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006109 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request inspect-delay"
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006110
6111
6112tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
6113 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
6114 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02006115 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006116 Arguments :
6117 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6118 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6119 as explained at the top of this document.
6120
6121 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
6122 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
6123 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
6124 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
6125 data for at most the specified amount of time.
6126
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02006127 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
6128 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
6129 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
6130 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
6131
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006132 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
6133 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006134 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006135 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +01006136 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
6137 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
6138 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
6139 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006140
6141 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
6142 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
6143 it pass through unaffected.
6144
6145 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
6146 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
6147 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006148 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006149 before the server (eg: SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
6150 data to the server (eg: SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +02006151 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
6152 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
6153 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006154
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006155 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006156 "timeout client".
6157
6158
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02006159tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
6160 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
6161 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6162 no | no | yes | yes
6163 Arguments :
6164 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
6165 actions include : "accept", "reject".
6166 See "tcp-request connection" above for their signification.
6167
6168 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
6169
6170 Response contents can be analysed at an early stage of response processing
6171 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
6172 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
6173 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection delay is
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006174 set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02006175
6176 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
6177
6178 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
6179 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
6180 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
6181 inserted.
6182
6183 Two types of actions are supported :
6184 - accept :
6185 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
6186 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
6187 the rules evaluation.
6188
6189 - reject :
6190 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
6191 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006192 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02006193
6194 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
6195 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
6196 for changing the default action to a reject.
6197
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006198 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
6199 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
6200 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
6201 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02006202 period.
6203
6204 See section 7 about ACL usage.
6205
6206 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
6207
6208
6209tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
6210 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
6211 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6212 no | no | yes | yes
6213 Arguments :
6214 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6215 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6216 as explained at the top of this document.
6217
6218 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
6219
6220
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01006221timeout check <timeout>
6222 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
6223 established.
6224
6225 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6226 yes | no | yes | yes
6227 Arguments:
6228 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6229 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6230 as explained at the top of this document.
6231
6232 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
6233 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
6234 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (eg. those
6235 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +01006236 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
6237 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
6238 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01006239
6240 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
6241 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
6242
6243 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
6244 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01006245 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01006246
6247 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
6248 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
6249 forget about it.
6250
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01006251 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
6252 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01006253
6254
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006255timeout client <timeout>
6256timeout clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
6257 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
6258 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6259 yes | yes | yes | no
6260 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006261 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006262 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6263 as explained at the top of this document.
6264
6265 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
6266 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
6267 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
6268 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
6269 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
6270 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
6271 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
6272 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006273 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006274 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006275 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
6276 sessions (eg: WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
6277 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006278
6279 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
6280 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
6281 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
6282 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
6283 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
6284 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
6285
6286 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "clitimeout". It is recommended
6287 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout clitimeout" is
6288 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
6289
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006290 See also : "clitimeout", "timeout server", "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006291
6292
6293timeout connect <timeout>
6294timeout contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
6295 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
6296 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6297 yes | no | yes | yes
6298 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006299 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006300 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6301 as explained at the top of this document.
6302
6303 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006304 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006305 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006306 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01006307 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
6308 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006309
6310 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
6311 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
6312 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
6313 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
6314 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
6315 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
6316
6317 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "contimeout". It is recommended
6318 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout contimeout" is
6319 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
6320
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01006321 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "contimeout",
6322 "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006323
6324
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01006325timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
6326 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
6327 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6328 yes | yes | yes | yes
6329 Arguments :
6330 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6331 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6332 as explained at the top of this document.
6333
6334 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
6335 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
6336 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
6337 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
6338 once the request has started to present itself.
6339
6340 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
6341 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
6342 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
6343 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
6344 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
6345
6346 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
6347 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
6348 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
6349 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
6350
6351 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
6352 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
6353 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (eg:
6354 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
6355 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +02006356 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01006357
6358 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
6359 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
6360 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
6361 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
6362
6363 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
6364
6365
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006366timeout http-request <timeout>
6367 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
6368 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02006369 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006370 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006371 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006372 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6373 as explained at the top of this document.
6374
6375 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
6376 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
6377 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
6378 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
6379 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
6380 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
6381 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
6382 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time.
6383
6384 Note that this timeout only applies to the header part of the request, and
6385 not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is not
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01006386 used anymore. It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
6387 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006388
6389 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
6390 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
6391 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (eg: 50 ms) will
6392 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
6393 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
6394
6395 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02006396 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
6397 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
6398 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006399
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01006400 See also : "timeout http-keep-alive", "timeout client".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006401
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006402
6403timeout queue <timeout>
6404 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
6405 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6406 yes | no | yes | yes
6407 Arguments :
6408 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6409 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6410 as explained at the top of this document.
6411
6412 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
6413 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
6414 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
6415 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
6416 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
6417
6418 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
6419 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
6420 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
6421 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
6422
6423 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
6424
6425
6426timeout server <timeout>
6427timeout srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
6428 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
6429 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6430 yes | no | yes | yes
6431 Arguments :
6432 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6433 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6434 as explained at the top of this document.
6435
6436 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
6437 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
6438 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
6439 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
6440 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
6441 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
6442 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
6443
6444 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
6445 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
6446 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
6447 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
6448 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006449 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006450 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006451 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
6452 with short-lived sessions (eg: WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
6453 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
6454 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006455
6456 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
6457 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
6458 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
6459 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
6460 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
6461 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
6462
6463 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "srvtimeout". It is recommended
6464 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout srvtimeout" is
6465 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
6466
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006467 See also : "srvtimeout", "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006468
6469
6470timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01006471 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006472 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6473 yes | yes | yes | yes
6474 Arguments :
6475 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
6476 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6477 as explained at the top of this document.
6478
6479 When a connection is tarpitted using "reqtarpit", it is maintained open with
6480 no activity for a certain amount of time, then closed. "timeout tarpit"
6481 defines how long it will be maintained open.
6482
6483 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
6484 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
6485 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
6486 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01006487 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006488
6489 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
6490
6491
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006492timeout tunnel <timeout>
6493 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
6494 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6495 yes | no | yes | yes
6496 Arguments :
6497 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6498 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6499 as explained at the top of this document.
6500
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006501 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006502 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
6503 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
6504 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
6505 analyser remains attached to either connection (eg: tcp content rules are
6506 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (eg:
6507 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
6508 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
6509 specified.
6510
6511 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
6512 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
6513 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
6514 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
6515 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
6516
6517 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
6518 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
6519 forget about it.
6520
6521 Example :
6522 defaults http
6523 option http-server-close
6524 timeout connect 5s
6525 timeout client 30s
6526 timeout client 30s
6527 timeout server 30s
6528 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
6529
6530 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server".
6531
6532
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006533transparent (deprecated)
6534 Enable client-side transparent proxying
6535 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01006536 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006537 Arguments : none
6538
6539 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
6540 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
6541 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
6542 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
6543 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
6544 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
6545 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
6546 appropriate server.
6547
6548 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
6549
6550 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
6551 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
6552
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006553 See also: "option transparent"
6554
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01006555unique-id-format <string>
6556 Generate a unique ID for each request.
6557 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6558 yes | yes | yes | no
6559 Arguments :
6560 <string> is a log-format string.
6561
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006562 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
6563 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
6564 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
6565 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01006566
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006567 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
6568 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple haproxy instances
6569 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
6570 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
6571 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
6572 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
6573 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
6574 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01006575
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006576 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
6577 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01006578
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006579 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01006580
6581 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %Ci:%Cp_%Fi:%Fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
6582
6583 will generate:
6584
6585 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
6586
6587 See also: "unique-id-header"
6588
6589unique-id-header <name>
6590 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
6591 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6592 yes | yes | yes | no
6593 Arguments :
6594 <name> is the name of the header.
6595
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006596 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
6597 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01006598
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006599 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01006600
6601 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %Ci:%Cp_%Fi:%Fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
6602 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
6603
6604 will generate:
6605
6606 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
6607
6608 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006609
6610use_backend <backend> if <condition>
6611use_backend <backend> unless <condition>
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02006612 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006613 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6614 no | yes | yes | no
6615 Arguments :
6616 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section.
6617
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006618 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006619
6620 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
6621 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
6622 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02006623 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
6624 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (eg:
6625 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
6626 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006627
6628 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
6629 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
6630 assign the backend.
6631
6632 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
6633 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
6634 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
6635 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
6636 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
6637 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
6638
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +02006639 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006640 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +02006641 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
6642 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
6643 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
6644
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02006645 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006646
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006647
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02006648use-server <server> if <condition>
6649use-server <server> unless <condition>
6650 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
6651 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6652 no | no | yes | yes
6653 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006654 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02006655
6656 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
6657
6658 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
6659 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
6660 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
6661
6662 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
6663 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
6664 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
6665 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
6666 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
6667 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
6668 matches will assign the server.
6669
6670 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
6671 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
6672 with the next rules until one matches.
6673
6674 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
6675 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
6676 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
6677 according to other persistence mechanisms.
6678
6679 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
6680 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
6681 stripped.
6682
6683 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
6684 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
6685 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field. And if these servers
6686 have their weight set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
6687
6688 Example :
6689 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
6690 use-server www if { req_ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
6691 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
6692 use-server mail if { req_ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
6693 server mail 192.168.0.1:587 weight 0
6694 use-server imap if { req_ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
6695 server mail 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
6696 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
6697 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
6698
6699 See also: "use_backend", serction 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
6700
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02006701
67025. Bind and Server options
6703--------------------------
6704
6705The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
6706depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
6707settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
6708written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
6709described in this section.
6710
6711
67125.1. Bind options
6713-----------------
6714
6715The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
6716as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
6717no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
6718parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
6719while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
6720provided immediately after the setting name.
6721
6722The currently supported settings are the following ones.
6723
6724accept-proxy
6725 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
6726 the sockets declared on the same line. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
6727 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
6728 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
6729 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
6730 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
6731 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
6732 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
6733 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
6734 usable.
6735
6736backlog <backlog>
6737 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified, the frontend's
6738 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
6739
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +02006740ecdhe <named curve>
6741 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
6742 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys and makes
6743 ECDHE cipher suites usable.
6744
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02006745cafile <cafile>
6746 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
6747 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
6748 client's certificate.
6749
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +02006750ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
6751 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
6752 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
6753 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
6754 error is ignored.
6755
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02006756ciphers <ciphers>
6757 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
6758 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
6759 negociated during the SSL/TLS handshake. The format of the string is defined
6760 in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages, and can be for instance a string
6761 such as "AES:ALL:!aNULL:!eNULL:+RC4:@STRENGTH" (without quotes).
6762
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02006763crlfile <cafile>
6764 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
6765 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
6766 to verify client's certificate.
6767
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02006768crt <cert>
6769 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
6770 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
6771 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +02006772 files into one. If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters
6773 present in this file are also loaded. If a directory name is used instead of a
6774 PEM file, then all files found in that directory will be loaded. This
6775 directive may be specified multiple times in order to load certificates from
6776 multiple files or directories. The certificates will be presented to clients
6777 who provide a valid TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of their CN
6778 or alt subjects. Wildcards are supported, where a wildcard character '*' is
6779 used instead of the first hostname component (eg: *.example.org matches
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02006780 www.example.org but not www.sub.example.org). If no SNI is provided by the
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +02006781 client or if the SSL library does not support TLS extensions, or if the client
6782 provides and SNI which does not match any certificate, then the first loaded
6783 certificate will be presented. This means that when loading certificates from
6784 a directory, it is highly recommended to load the default one first as a file.
6785 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02006786
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +02006787crt-ignore-err <errors>
6788 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
6789 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0.
6790 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not abored if an
6791 error is ignored.
6792
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02006793defer-accept
6794 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
6795 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
6796 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
6797 for which the client talks first (eg: HTTP). It can slightly improve
6798 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
6799 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
6800 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
6801 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
6802 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
6803 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
6804 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
6805
6806gid <gid>
6807 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
6808 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
6809 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
6810 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
6811 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
6812
6813group <group>
6814 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
6815 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
6816 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
6817 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
6818 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
6819
6820id <id>
6821 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
6822 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
6823 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
6824 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
6825
6826interface <interface>
6827 Sets the name of the network interface to listen. This is currently only
6828 supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system interface, not an
6829 aliased interface. When specified, all addresses on the same line will only
6830 be accepted if the incoming packets physically come through the designated
6831 interface. It is also possible to bind multiple frontends to the same address
6832 if they are bound to different interfaces. Note that binding to a network
6833 interface requires root privileges. This parameter is only compatible with
6834 TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets.
6835
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02006836level <level>
6837 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
6838 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
6839 sockets. <level> can be one of :
6840 - "user" is the least privileged level ; only non-sensitive stats can be
6841 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
6842 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
6843 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
6844 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (eg: clear max
6845 counters).
6846 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (eg: clear
6847 all counters).
6848
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02006849maxconn <maxconn>
6850 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
6851 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
6852 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
6853 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
6854 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
6855 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
6856 eat all memory.
6857
6858mode <mode>
6859 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
6860 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
6861 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
6862 UNIX sockets.
6863
6864mss <maxseg>
6865 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
6866 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
6867 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
6868 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
6869 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
6870 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
6871 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
6872 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
6873 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
6874 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
6875 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
6876
6877name <name>
6878 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
6879 page.
6880
6881nice <nice>
6882 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
6883 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
6884 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
6885 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
6886 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
6887 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
6888 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
6889 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
6890 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
6891 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
6892 one for an RDP socket.
6893
6894nosslv3
6895 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
6896 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instanciated from the listener when
6897 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
6898 be enabled using any configuration option.
6899
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +02006900no-tls-tickets
6901 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
6902 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
6903 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
6904 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage.
6905
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02006906notlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02006907 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02006908 disables support for TLSv10 on any sockets instanciated from the listener when
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02006909 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
6910 be enabled using any configuration option.
6911
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02006912notlsv11
6913 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
6914 disables support for TLSv11 on any sockets instanciated from the listener when
6915 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
6916 be enabled using any configuration option.
6917
6918notlsv12
6919 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
6920 disables support for TLSv12 on any sockets instanciated from the listener when
6921 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
6922 be enabled using any configuration option.
6923
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02006924prefer-server-ciphers
6925 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
6926 tells the SSL/TLS layer that our set of cipher algorithms is preferred over
6927 the client's ones.
6928
6929ssl
6930 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
6931 enables SSL deciphering on connections instanciated from this listener. A
6932 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
6933 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
6934 to deciphered contents.
6935
6936transparent
6937 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
6938 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
6939 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
6940 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
6941 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
6942 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
6943 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
6944 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
6945 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
6946 so check for support with your vendor.
6947
6948uid <uid>
6949 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
6950 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
6951 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
6952 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
6953 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
6954
6955user <user>
6956 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
6957 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
6958 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
6959 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
6960 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
6961
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02006962verify [none|optional|required]
6963 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
6964 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
6965 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
6966 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
6967 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
6968 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from 'cafile'
6969 and optional CRLs from 'crlfile'. On verify failure the handshake is aborted,
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +02006970 regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly matches one
6971 of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02006972
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020069735.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01006974------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006975
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01006976The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
6977which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
6978arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
6979settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
6980after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
6981Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
6982address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006983
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006984 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01006985 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006986
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006987The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006988
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02006989addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006990 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
6991 to send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate an IP
6992 address to specific component able to perform complex tests which are more
6993 suitable to health-checks than the application. This parameter is ignored if
6994 the "check" parameter is not set. See also the "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006995
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006996 Supported in default-server: No
6997
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006998backup
6999 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
7000 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
7001 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
7002 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
7003 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "allbackups"
7004 option.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007005
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007006 Supported in default-server: No
7007
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007008check
7009 This option enables health checks on the server. By default, a server is
Patrick Mézardb7aeec62012-01-22 16:01:22 +01007010 always considered available. If "check" is set, the server is available when
7011 accepting periodic TCP connections, to ensure that it is really able to serve
7012 requests. The default address and port to send the tests to are those of the
7013 server, and the default source is the same as the one defined in the
7014 backend. It is possible to change the address using the "addr" parameter, the
7015 port using the "port" parameter, the source address using the "source"
7016 address, and the interval and timers using the "inter", "rise" and "fall"
7017 parameters. The request method is define in the backend using the "httpchk",
7018 "smtpchk", "mysql-check", "pgsql-check" and "ssl-hello-chk" options. Please
7019 refer to those options and parameters for more information.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007020
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007021 Supported in default-server: No
7022
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02007023ciphers <ciphers>
7024 This option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
7025 is negociated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
7026 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers". When SSL is used to communicate with
7027 servers on the local network, it is common to see a weaker set of algorithms
7028 than what is used over the internet. Doing so reduces CPU usage on both the
7029 server and haproxy while still keeping it compatible with deployed software.
7030 Some algorithms such as RC4-SHA1 are reasonably cheap. If no security at all
7031 is needed and just connectivity, using DES can be appropriate.
7032
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007033cookie <value>
7034 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
7035 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
7036 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
7037 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
7038 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
7039 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
7040 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
7041
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007042 Supported in default-server: No
7043
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +02007044disabled
7045 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
7046 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
7047 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
7048 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
7049 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
7050
7051 Supported in default-server: No
7052
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007053error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01007054 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
7055 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
7056 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01007057
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007058 Supported in default-server: Yes
7059
7060 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01007061
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007062fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007063 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
7064 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
7065 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
7066
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007067 Supported in default-server: Yes
7068
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007069id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02007070 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
7071 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
7072 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007073
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007074 Supported in default-server: No
7075
7076inter <delay>
7077fastinter <delay>
7078downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007079 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
7080 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
7081 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
7082 between checks depending on the server state :
7083
7084 Server state | Interval used
7085 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
7086 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
7087 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
7088 Transitionally UP (going down), |
7089 Transitionally DOWN (going up), | "fastinter" if set, "inter" otherwise.
7090 or yet unchecked. |
7091 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
7092 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set, "inter" otherwise.
7093 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007094
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007095 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
7096 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
7097 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
7098 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
7099 hosted on the same hardware, the health-checks of all servers are started
7100 with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to add some random
7101 noise in the health checks interval using the global "spread-checks"
7102 keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot of backends use the same
7103 servers.
7104
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007105 Supported in default-server: Yes
7106
7107maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007108 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
7109 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
7110 concurrent requests goes higher than this value, they will be queued, waiting
7111 for a connection to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
7112 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
7113 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
7114 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
7115 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
7116
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007117 Supported in default-server: Yes
7118
7119maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007120 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
7121 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
7122 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
7123 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
7124 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. The
7125 default value is "0" which means the queue is unlimited. See also the
7126 "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters.
7127
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007128 Supported in default-server: Yes
7129
7130minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007131 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
7132 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
7133 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
7134 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
7135 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
7136 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007137 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007138 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01007139
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007140 Supported in default-server: Yes
7141
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02007142nosslv3
7143 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
7144 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
7145 using any configuration option.
7146
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02007147notlsv10
7148 This option disables support for TLSv10 when SSL is used to communicate with
7149 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
7150 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
7151 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers.
7152
7153notlsv11
7154 This option disables support for TLSv11 when SSL is used to communicate with
7155 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
7156 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
7157 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers.
7158
7159notlsv12
7160 This option disables support for TLSv12 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02007161 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
7162 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
7163 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers.
7164
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +09007165non-stick
7166 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
7167 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
7168 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
7169
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01007170observe <mode>
7171 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
7172 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
7173 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
7174 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
7175 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
7176 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +01007177 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01007178
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007179 Supported in default-server: No
7180
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01007181 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
7182
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007183on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01007184 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
7185 Currently, four modes are available:
7186 - fastinter: force fastinter
7187 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
7188 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
7189 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
7190 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
7191
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007192 Supported in default-server: Yes
7193
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01007194 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
7195
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +09007196on-marked-down <action>
7197 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
7198 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -07007199 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
7200 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
7201 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
7202 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
7203 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
7204 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
7205 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
7206 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +09007207
7208 Actions are disabled by default
7209
7210 Supported in default-server: Yes
7211
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -07007212on-marked-up <action>
7213 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
7214 Currently one action is available:
7215 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
7216 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
7217 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
7218 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
7219 with long sessions (eg: LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
7220 than it tries to solve (eg: incomplete transactions), so use this feature
7221 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
7222 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
7223
7224 Actions are disabled by default
7225
7226 Supported in default-server: Yes
7227
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007228port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007229 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
7230 send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate a port
7231 to a specific component able to perform complex tests which are more suitable
7232 to health-checks than the application. It is common to run a simple script in
7233 inetd for instance. This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not
7234 set. See also the "addr" parameter.
7235
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007236 Supported in default-server: Yes
7237
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007238redir <prefix>
7239 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
7240 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
7241 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
7242 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
7243 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
7244 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
7245 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
7246 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007247 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007248 requests are still analysed, making this solution completely usable to direct
7249 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
7250 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
7251 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
7252 loop between the client and HAProxy!
7253
7254 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
7255
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007256 Supported in default-server: No
7257
7258rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007259 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
7260 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
7261 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
7262
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007263 Supported in default-server: Yes
7264
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +01007265send-proxy
7266 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
7267 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
7268 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
7269 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
7270 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" listener,
7271 the advertised address will be used. Only TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families
7272 are supported. Other families such as Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN
7273 family. Servers using this option can fully be chained to another instance of
7274 haproxy listening with an "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be
7275 used if the server isn't aware of the protocol. See also the "accept-proxy"
7276 option of the "bind" keyword.
7277
7278 Supported in default-server: No
7279
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007280slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007281 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
7282 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
7283 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
7284 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
7285 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
7286 parameters :
7287
7288 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
7289 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
7290
7291 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
7292 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
7293 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
7294 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
7295
7296 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
7297 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
7298 seen as failed.
7299
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007300 Supported in default-server: Yes
7301
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02007302source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02007303source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02007304source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007305 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
7306 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
7307 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
7308 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
7309
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02007310 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
7311 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
7312 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
7313 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
7314 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
7315 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
7316 server.
7317
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007318 Supported in default-server: No
7319
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02007320ssl
7321 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. At
7322 the moment, server certificates are not checked, so this is prone to man in
7323 the middle attacks. The real intended use is to permit SSL communication
7324 with software which cannot work in other modes over networks that would
7325 otherwise be considered safe enough for clear text communications.
7326
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007327track [<proxy>/]<server>
7328 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by
7329 tracking another one. Only a server with checks enabled can be tracked
7330 so it is not possible for example to track a server that tracks another
7331 one. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
7332 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
7333
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007334 Supported in default-server: No
7335
7336weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007337 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
7338 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
7339 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +02007340 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
7341 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
7342 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
7343 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
7344 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
7345 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007346
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007347 Supported in default-server: Yes
7348
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007349
73506. HTTP header manipulation
7351---------------------------
7352
7353In HTTP mode, it is possible to rewrite, add or delete some of the request and
7354response headers based on regular expressions. It is also possible to block a
7355request or a response if a particular header matches a regular expression,
7356which is enough to stop most elementary protocol attacks, and to protect
7357against information leak from the internal network. But there is a limitation
7358to this : since HAProxy's HTTP engine does not support keep-alive, only headers
7359passed during the first request of a TCP session will be seen. All subsequent
7360headers will be considered data only and not analyzed. Furthermore, HAProxy
7361never touches data contents, it stops analysis at the end of headers.
7362
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +02007363There is an exception though. If HAProxy encounters an "Informational Response"
7364(status code 1xx), it is able to process all rsp* rules which can allow, deny,
7365rewrite or delete a header, but it will refuse to add a header to any such
7366messages as this is not HTTP-compliant. The reason for still processing headers
7367in such responses is to stop and/or fix any possible information leak which may
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007368happen, for instance because another downstream equipment would unconditionally
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +02007369add a header, or if a server name appears there. When such messages are seen,
7370normal processing still occurs on the next non-informational messages.
7371
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007372This section covers common usage of the following keywords, described in detail
7373in section 4.2 :
7374
7375 - reqadd <string>
7376 - reqallow <search>
7377 - reqiallow <search>
7378 - reqdel <search>
7379 - reqidel <search>
7380 - reqdeny <search>
7381 - reqideny <search>
7382 - reqpass <search>
7383 - reqipass <search>
7384 - reqrep <search> <replace>
7385 - reqirep <search> <replace>
7386 - reqtarpit <search>
7387 - reqitarpit <search>
7388 - rspadd <string>
7389 - rspdel <search>
7390 - rspidel <search>
7391 - rspdeny <search>
7392 - rspideny <search>
7393 - rsprep <search> <replace>
7394 - rspirep <search> <replace>
7395
7396With all these keywords, the same conventions are used. The <search> parameter
7397is a POSIX extended regular expression (regex) which supports grouping through
7398parenthesis (without the backslash). Spaces and other delimiters must be
7399prefixed with a backslash ('\') to avoid confusion with a field delimiter.
7400Other characters may be prefixed with a backslash to change their meaning :
7401
7402 \t for a tab
7403 \r for a carriage return (CR)
7404 \n for a new line (LF)
7405 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
7406 \# to mark a sharp and differentiate it from a comment
7407 \\ to use a backslash in a regex
7408 \\\\ to use a backslash in the text (*2 for regex, *2 for haproxy)
7409 \xXX to write the ASCII hex code XX as in the C language
7410
7411The <replace> parameter contains the string to be used to replace the largest
7412portion of text matching the regex. It can make use of the special characters
7413above, and can reference a substring which is delimited by parenthesis in the
7414regex, by writing a backslash ('\') immediately followed by one digit from 0 to
74159 indicating the group position (0 designating the entire line). This practice
7416is very common to users of the "sed" program.
7417
7418The <string> parameter represents the string which will systematically be added
7419after the last header line. It can also use special character sequences above.
7420
7421Notes related to these keywords :
7422---------------------------------
7423 - these keywords are not always convenient to allow/deny based on header
7424 contents. It is strongly recommended to use ACLs with the "block" keyword
7425 instead, resulting in far more flexible and manageable rules.
7426
7427 - lines are always considered as a whole. It is not possible to reference
7428 a header name only or a value only. This is important because of the way
7429 headers are written (notably the number of spaces after the colon).
7430
7431 - the first line is always considered as a header, which makes it possible to
7432 rewrite or filter HTTP requests URIs or response codes, but in turn makes
7433 it harder to distinguish between headers and request line. The regex prefix
7434 ^[^\ \t]*[\ \t] matches any HTTP method followed by a space, and the prefix
7435 ^[^ \t:]*: matches any header name followed by a colon.
7436
7437 - for performances reasons, the number of characters added to a request or to
7438 a response is limited at build time to values between 1 and 4 kB. This
7439 should normally be far more than enough for most usages. If it is too short
7440 on occasional usages, it is possible to gain some space by removing some
7441 useless headers before adding new ones.
7442
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007443 - keywords beginning with "reqi" and "rspi" are the same as their counterpart
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007444 without the 'i' letter except that they ignore case when matching patterns.
7445
7446 - when a request passes through a frontend then a backend, all req* rules
7447 from the frontend will be evaluated, then all req* rules from the backend
7448 will be evaluated. The reverse path is applied to responses.
7449
7450 - req* statements are applied after "block" statements, so that "block" is
7451 always the first one, but before "use_backend" in order to permit rewriting
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007452 before switching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007453
7454
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010074557. Using ACLs and pattern extraction
7456------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007457
7458The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
7459content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
7460from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
7461simple :
7462
7463 - define test criteria with sets of values
7464 - perform actions only if a set of tests is valid
7465
7466The actions generally consist in blocking the request, or selecting a backend.
7467
7468In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
7469
7470 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
7471
7472This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
7473Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
7474and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
7475an operator which may be specified before the set of values. The values are
7476of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
7477
7478ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
7479'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
7480which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
7481
7482There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
7483performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
7484
7485The following ACL flags are currently supported :
7486
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02007487 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
7488 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007489 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
7490
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02007491The "-f" flag is special as it loads all of the lines it finds in the file
7492specified in argument and loads all of them before continuing. It is even
7493possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments if the patterns are to be loaded from
Willy Tarreau58215a02010-05-13 22:07:43 +02007494multiple files. Empty lines as well as lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will
7495be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs will be stripped. If it is absolutely
7496needed to insert a valid pattern beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a
7497space so that it is not taken for a comment. Depending on the data type and
7498match method, haproxy may load the lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast
7499lookups. This is true for IPv4 and exact string matching. In this case,
7500duplicates will automatically be removed. Also, note that the "-i" flag applies
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007501to subsequent entries and not to entries loaded from files preceding it. For
Willy Tarreau58215a02010-05-13 22:07:43 +02007502instance :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02007503
7504 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
7505
7506In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
7507the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
7508case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
7509too.
7510
7511Note that right now it is difficult for the ACL parsers to report errors, so if
7512a file is unreadable or unparsable, the most you'll get is a parse error in the
7513ACL. Thus, file-based ACLs should only be produced by reliable processes.
7514
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007515Supported types of values are :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007516
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007517 - integers or integer ranges
7518 - strings
7519 - regular expressions
7520 - IP addresses and networks
7521
7522
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020075237.1. Matching integers
7524----------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007525
7526Matching integers is special in that ranges and operators are permitted. Note
7527that integer matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value
7528expressed with a lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which
7529may be omitted.
7530
7531For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
7532unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
7533representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
7534
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007535As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
7536two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
7537instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
7538ranges and operators.
7539
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007540For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007541operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
7542Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
7543of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007544
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007545Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007546
7547 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
7548 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
7549 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
7550 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
7551 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
7552
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007553For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007554
7555 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
7556
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007557This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
7558
7559 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
7560
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007561
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020075627.2. Matching strings
7563---------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007564
7565String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
7566exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
7567characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
7568string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
7569to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007570before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007571
7572
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020075737.3. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
7574-------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007575
7576Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
7577they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
7578possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
7579passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
7580the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007581the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
7582match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007583
7584
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020075857.4. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007586----------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007587
7588IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
7589netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
7590within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007591host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007592difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
7593at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
7594does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
7595parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007596
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02007597IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
7598Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
7599trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
7600IPv6 patterns.
7601
7602HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
7603following situations :
7604 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
7605 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
7606 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
7607 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
7608 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
7609 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
7610 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
7611 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
7612 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
7613 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
7614
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007615
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020076167.5. Available matching criteria
7617--------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007618
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020076197.5.1. Matching at Layer 4 and below
7620------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007621
7622A first set of criteria applies to information which does not require any
7623analysis of the request or response contents. Those generally include TCP/IP
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007624addresses and ports, as well as internal values independent on the stream.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007625
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007626always_false
7627 This one never matches. All values and flags are ignored. It may be used as
7628 a temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
7629
7630always_true
7631 This one always matches. All values and flags are ignored. It may be used as
7632 a temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
7633
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007634avg_queue <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007635avg_queue(<backend>) <integer>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007636 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
7637 divided by the number of active servers. This is very similar to "queue"
7638 except that the size of the farm is considered, in order to give a more
7639 accurate measurement of the time it may take for a new connection to be
7640 processed. The main usage is to return a sorry page to new users when it
7641 becomes certain they will get a degraded service. Note that in the event
7642 there would not be any active server anymore, we would consider twice the
7643 number of queued connections as the measured value. This is a fair estimate,
7644 as we expect one server to get back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send
7645 new traffic to another backend if in better shape. See also the "queue",
7646 "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +01007647
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02007648be_conn <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007649be_conn(<backend>) <integer>
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02007650 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
7651 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
7652 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
7653 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
7654 See also the "fe_conn", "queue" and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007655
Hervé COMMOWICK35ed8012010-12-15 14:04:51 +01007656be_id <integer>
7657 Applies to the backend's id. Can be used in frontends to check from which
7658 backend it was called.
7659
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007660be_sess_rate <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007661be_sess_rate(<backend>) <integer>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007662 Returns true when the sessions creation rate on the backend matches the
7663 specified values or ranges, in number of new sessions per second. This is
7664 used to switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one
7665 reaches too high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (eg. prevent
7666 sucking of an online dictionary).
7667
7668 Example :
7669 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
7670 backend dynamic
7671 mode http
7672 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
7673 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007674
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08007675connslots <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007676connslots(<backend>) <integer>
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08007677 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007678 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08007679 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
7680
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007681 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
7682 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08007683
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02007684 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007685 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
7686 multiple backends (perhaps using acls to do name-based load balancing) and
7687 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
7688 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
7689 actually *down*, this acl is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02007690 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08007691
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007692 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
7693 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
7694 then this acl clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
7695 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08007696
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007697dst <ip_address>
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02007698 Applies to the local IPv4 or IPv6 address the client connected to. It can be
7699 used to switch to a different backend for some alternative addresses.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02007700
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007701dst_conn <integer>
7702 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the same socket
7703 including the one being evaluated. It can be used to either return a sorry
7704 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
7705 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
7706 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
7707 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" criteria.
7708
7709dst_port <integer>
7710 Applies to the local port the client connected to. It can be used to switch
7711 to a different backend for some alternative ports.
7712
7713fe_conn <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007714fe_conn(<frontend>) <integer>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007715 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
7716 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
7717 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
7718 frontend. It can be used to either return a sorry page before hard-blocking,
7719 or to use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is
7720 considered saturated. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn" and "fe_sess_rate"
7721 criteria.
7722
7723fe_id <integer>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01007724 Applies to the frontend's id. Can be used in backends to check from which
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007725 frontend it was called.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02007726
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +01007727fe_sess_rate <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007728fe_sess_rate(<frontend>) <integer>
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +01007729 Returns true when the session creation rate on the current or the named
7730 frontend matches the specified values or ranges, expressed in new sessions
7731 per second. This is used to limit the connection rate to acceptable ranges in
7732 order to prevent abuse of service at the earliest moment. This can be
7733 combined with layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for
7734 the rate to go down below the limit.
7735
7736 Example :
7737 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
7738 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
7739 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
7740 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
7741 frontend mail
7742 bind :25
7743 mode tcp
7744 maxconn 100
7745 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
7746 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
7747 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
7748 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007749
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007750nbsrv <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007751nbsrv(<backend>) <integer>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007752 Returns true when the number of usable servers of either the current backend
7753 or the named backend matches the values or ranges specified. This is used to
7754 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
7755 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
7756 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +01007757
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007758queue <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007759queue(<backend>) <integer>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007760 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
7761 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
7762 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
7763 one. This can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level,
7764 generally indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers.
7765 One possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones.
7766 See also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
7767
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007768sc1_bytes_in_rate
7769sc2_bytes_in_rate
7770 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
7771 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
7772 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
7773
7774sc1_bytes_out_rate
7775sc2_bytes_out_rate
7776 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
7777 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
7778 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
7779
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +02007780sc1_clr_gpc0
7781sc2_clr_gpc0
7782 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
7783 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
7784 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. The test
7785 can also be used alone and always returns true. This is typically used as a
7786 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
7787 was verified :
7788
7789 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
7790 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
7791 acl abuse sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
7792 acl kill sc1_inc_gpc0 gt 5
7793 acl save sc1_clr_gpc0
7794 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
7795 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
7796
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007797sc1_conn_cnt
7798sc2_conn_cnt
7799 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections from currently tracked
7800 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
7801
7802sc1_conn_cur
7803sc2_conn_cur
7804 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
7805 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
7806 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
7807
7808sc1_conn_rate
7809sc2_conn_rate
7810 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
7811 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
7812 See also src_conn_rate.
7813
7814sc1_get_gpc0
7815sc2_get_gpc0
7816 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
7817 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
7818
7819sc1_http_err_cnt
7820sc2_http_err_cnt
7821 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
7822 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
7823 See also src_http_err_cnt.
7824
7825sc1_http_err_rate
7826sc2_http_err_rate
7827 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
7828 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
7829 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
7830 src_http_err_rate.
7831
7832sc1_http_req_cnt
7833sc2_http_req_cnt
7834 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
7835 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
7836 src_http_req_cnt.
7837
7838sc1_http_req_rate
7839sc2_http_req_rate
7840 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
7841 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
7842 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
7843 src_http_req_rate.
7844
7845sc1_inc_gpc0
7846sc2_inc_gpc0
7847 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
7848 tracked counters, and returns its value. Before the first invocation, the
7849 stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
7850 return 1. The test can also be used alone and always returns true. This is
7851 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
7852 when a first ACL was verified :
7853
7854 acl abuse sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
7855 acl kill sc1_inc_gpc0
7856 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
7857
7858sc1_kbytes_in
7859sc2_kbytes_in
7860 Returns the amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
7861 counters, measured in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. The
7862 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
7863 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
7864
7865sc1_kbytes_out
7866sc2_kbytes_out
7867 Returns the amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
7868 counters, measured in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. The
7869 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
7870 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
7871
7872sc1_sess_cnt
7873sc2_sess_cnt
7874 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections that were transformed
7875 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
7876 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
7877 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007878 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007879 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
7880
7881sc1_sess_rate
7882sc2_sess_rate
7883 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
7884 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
7885 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
7886 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
7887 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007888 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007889
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007890so_id <integer>
7891 Applies to the socket's id. Useful in frontends with many bind keywords.
7892
7893src <ip_address>
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02007894 Applies to the client's IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is usually used to limit
7895 access to certain resources such as statistics. Note that it is the TCP-level
7896 source address which is used, and not the address of a client behind a proxy.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007897
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007898src_bytes_in_rate <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007899src_bytes_in_rate(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007900 Returns the average bytes rate from the connection's source IPv4 address in
7901 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
7902 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007903 not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007904
7905src_bytes_out_rate <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007906src_bytes_out_rate(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007907 Returns the average bytes rate to the connection's source IPv4 address in the
7908 current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
7909 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007910 not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007911
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +02007912src_clr_gpc0 <integer>
7913src_clr_gpc0(<table>) <integer>
7914 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the connection's
7915 source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
7916 stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not found, an
7917 entry is created and 0 is returned. The test can also be used alone and
7918 always returns true. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression
7919 in order to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
7920
7921 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
7922 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
7923 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
7924 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
7925 acl save src_clr_gpc0
7926 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
7927 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
7928
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007929src_conn_cnt <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007930src_conn_cnt(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007931 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the current
7932 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
7933 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007934 See also sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007935
7936src_conn_cur <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007937src_conn_cur(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007938 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
7939 current connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table
7940 or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007941 returned. See also sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007942
7943src_conn_rate <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007944src_conn_rate(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007945 Returns the average connection rate from the connection's source IPv4 address
7946 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
7947 in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If the
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007948 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007949
7950src_get_gpc0 <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007951src_get_gpc0(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007952 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
7953 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
7954 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007955 See also sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007956
7957src_http_err_cnt <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007958src_http_err_cnt(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007959 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the current connection's
7960 source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
7961 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007962 If the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007963
7964src_http_err_rate <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007965src_http_err_rate(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007966 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the current connection's source
7967 IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
7968 table, measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table.
7969 This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007970 is not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007971
7972src_http_req_cnt <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007973src_http_req_cnt(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007974 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the current connection's
7975 source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
7976 stick-table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007977 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007978
7979src_http_req_rate <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007980src_http_req_rate(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007981 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the current connection's
7982 source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
7983 stick-table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
7984 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007985 not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007986
7987src_inc_gpc0 <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007988src_inc_gpc0(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007989 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the connection's
7990 source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
7991 stick-table, and returns its value. If the address is not found, an entry is
7992 created and 1 is returned. The test can also be used alone and always returns
7993 true. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to
7994 mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
7995
7996 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
7997 acl kill src_inc_gpc0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007998 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007999
8000src_kbytes_in <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008001src_kbytes_in(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008002 Returns the amount of data received from the connection's source IPv4 address
8003 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
8004 in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is not
8005 found, zero is returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008006 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008007
8008src_kbytes_out <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008009src_kbytes_out(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008010 Returns the amount of data sent to the connection's source IPv4 address in
8011 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
8012 in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is not
8013 found, zero is returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008014 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +02008015
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008016src_port <integer>
8017 Applies to the client's TCP source port. This has a very limited usage.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +01008018
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008019src_sess_cnt <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008020src_sess_cnt(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008021 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the current
8022 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
8023 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
8024 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008025 is returned. See also sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008026
8027src_sess_rate <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008028src_sess_rate(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008029 Returns the average session rate from the connection's source IPv4 address in
8030 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
8031 amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A session is a
8032 connection that got past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008033 found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008034
8035src_updt_conn_cnt <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008036src_updt_conn_cnt(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +02008037 Creates or updates the entry associated to the source IPv4 address in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008038 current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table. This table
8039 must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise the match
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +02008040 will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the expiration
8041 timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match can't return
8042 zero. This is used to reject service abusers based on their source address.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008043 Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-counters" instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +02008044
8045 Example :
8046 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
8047 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
8048 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
8049 listen ssh
8050 bind :22
8051 mode tcp
8052 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008053 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +02008054 tcp-request content reject if { src_update_count gt 3 }
8055 server local 127.0.0.1:22
8056
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008057srv_conn(<backend>/<server>) <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +02008058 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the server,
8059 possibly including the connection being evaluated.
8060 It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is full.
8061 See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn" and "queue" criteria.
8062
Hervé COMMOWICK35ed8012010-12-15 14:04:51 +01008063srv_id <integer>
8064 Applies to the server's id. Can be used in frontends or backends.
8065
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +02008066srv_is_up(<server>)
8067srv_is_up(<backend>/<server>)
8068 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
8069 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
8070 looked up in the current backend. The function takes no arguments since it
8071 is used as a boolean. It is mainly used to take action based on an external
8072 status reported via a health check (eg: a geographical site's availability).
8073 Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in using dummy servers
8074 as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from the CLI, so that
8075 rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
8076
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +02008077table_avl <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008078table_avl(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +02008079 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
8080 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
8081
8082table_cnt <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008083table_cnt(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +02008084 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
8085 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
8086 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
8087
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008088
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020080897.5.2. Matching contents at Layer 4 (also called Layer 6)
8090---------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008091
8092A second set of criteria depends on data found in buffers, but which can change
8093during analysis. This requires that some data has been buffered, for instance
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008094through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request content"
8095keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008096
Emeric Brunb4354082012-09-28 17:28:03 +02008097client_crt
8098 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +02008099 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brunb4354082012-09-28 17:28:03 +02008100
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02008101is_ssl
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +02008102 Returns true when the incoming connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
8103 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
8104 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02008105
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +01008106rep_ssl_hello_type <integer>
8107 Returns true when data in the response buffer looks like a complete SSL (v3
8108 or superior) hello message and handshake type is equal to <integer>.
8109 This test was designed to be used with TCP response content inspection: a
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02008110 SSL session ID may be fetched. Note that this only applies to raw contents
8111 found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data
8112 layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +01008113
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008114req_len <integer>
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +02008115 Returns true when the length of the data in the request buffer matches the
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008116 specified range. It is important to understand that this test does not
8117 return false as long as the buffer is changing. This means that a check with
8118 equality to zero will almost always immediately match at the beginning of the
8119 session, while a test for more data will wait for that data to come in and
8120 return false only when haproxy is certain that no more data will come in.
8121 This test was designed to be used with TCP request content inspection.
8122
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +02008123req_proto_http
8124 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
8125 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008126 is used so there should be no surprises. This test can be used for instance
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +02008127 to direct HTTP traffic to a given port and HTTPS traffic to another one
8128 using TCP request content inspection rules.
8129
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +02008130req_rdp_cookie <string>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008131req_rdp_cookie(<name>) <string>
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +02008132 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like the RDP protocol, and
8133 a cookie is present and equal to <string>. By default, any cookie name is
8134 checked, but a specific cookie name can be specified in parenthesis. The
8135 parser only checks for the first cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol
8136 specification. The cookie name is case insensitive. This ACL can be useful
8137 with the "MSTS" cookie, as it can contain the user name of the client
8138 connecting to the server if properly configured on the client. This can be
8139 used to restrict access to certain servers to certain users.
8140
8141req_rdp_cookie_cnt <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008142req_rdp_cookie_cnt(<name>) <integer>
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +02008143 Returns true when the data in the request buffer look like the RDP protocol
8144 and the number of RDP cookies matches the specified range (typically zero or
8145 one). Optionally a specific cookie name can be checked. This is a simple way
8146 of detecting the RDP protocol, as clients generally send the MSTS or MSTSHASH
8147 cookies.
8148
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +01008149req_ssl_hello_type <integer>
8150 Returns true when data in the request buffer looks like a complete SSL (v3
8151 or superior) hello message and handshake type is equal to <integer>.
8152 This test was designed to be used with TCP request content inspection: an
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02008153 SSL session ID may be fetched. Note that this only applies to raw contents
8154 found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data
8155 layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +01008156
8157req_ssl_sni <string>
8158 Returns true when data in the request buffer looks like a complete SSL (v3
8159 or superior) client hello message with a Server Name Indication TLS extension
8160 (SNI) matching <string>. SNI normally contains the name of the host the
8161 client tries to connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is useful for allowing
8162 or denying access to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used by the client. This
8163 test was designed to be used with TCP request content inspection. If content
8164 switching is needed, it is recommended to first wait for a complete client
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02008165 hello (type 1), like in the example below. Note that this only applies to raw
8166 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +02008167 SSL transport layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02008168 option. See also "ssl_sni" below.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +01008169
8170 Examples :
8171 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
8172 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
8173 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
8174 use_backend bk_allow if { req_ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
8175 default_backend bk_sorry_page
8176
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008177req_ssl_ver <decimal>
8178 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like SSL, with a protocol
8179 version matching the specified range. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
8180 messages are supported. The test tries to be strict enough to avoid being
8181 easily fooled. In particular, it waits for as many bytes as announced in the
8182 message header if this header looks valid (bound to the buffer size). Note
8183 that TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. This test was designed to be used
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02008184 with TCP request content inspection. Note that this only applies to raw
8185 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +02008186 SSL transport layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02008187 option.
8188
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02008189ssl_has_sni
8190 This is used to check for presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +02008191 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
8192 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
8193 that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
8194 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02008195
8196ssl_sni <string>
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +02008197 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8198 layer which deciphered it and found a Server Name Indication TLS extension
8199 sent by the client, matching the specified string. In HTTPS, the SNI field
8200 (when present) is equal to the requested host name. This match is different
8201 from req_ssl_sni above in that it applies to the connection being deciphered
8202 by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly forwarded. See also
8203 ssl_sni_end and ssl_sni_req below. This requires that the SSL library is
8204 build with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02008205
8206ssl_sni_end <string>
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +02008207 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8208 layer which deciphered it and found a Server Name Indication TLS extension
8209 sent by the client, ending like the specified string. In HTTPS, the SNI field
8210 (when present) is equal to the requested host name. This match is different
8211 from req_ssl_sni above in that it applies to the connection being deciphered
8212 by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly forwarded. This requires
8213 that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
8214 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02008215
8216ssl_sni_req <regex>
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +02008217 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8218 layer which deciphered it and found a Server Name Indication TLS extension
8219 sent by the client, matching the specified regex. In HTTPS, the SNI field
8220 (when present) is equal to the requested host name. This match is different
8221 from req_ssl_sni above in that it applies to the connection being deciphered
8222 by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly forwarded. This requires
8223 that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
8224 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008225
Emeric Brun3603fbe2012-09-28 18:35:15 +02008226ssl_verify_caerr <errorID>
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +02008227 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8228 layer and the ID of the first error detected during verify at depth > 0 match
8229 the errorID.
Emeric Brun3603fbe2012-09-28 18:35:15 +02008230
8231ssl_verify_caerr_depth <depth>
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +02008232 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8233 layer and the depth of the first error detected during verify match the
8234 depth.
Emeric Brun3603fbe2012-09-28 18:35:15 +02008235
8236ssl_verify_crterr <errorID>
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +02008237 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8238 layer and the ID of the first error detected during verify at depth == 0
8239 match the errorID.
Emeric Brun3603fbe2012-09-28 18:35:15 +02008240
Emeric Brunc68af8d2012-09-28 18:14:24 +02008241ssl_verify_result <errorID>
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +02008242 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8243 layer and the verify result match the errorID.
Emeric Brunc68af8d2012-09-28 18:14:24 +02008244
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +02008245wait_end
8246 Waits for the end of the analysis period to return true. This may be used in
8247 conjunction with content analysis to avoid returning a wrong verdict early.
8248 It may also be used to delay some actions, such as a delayed reject for some
8249 special addresses. Since it either stops the rules evaluation or immediately
8250 returns true, it is recommended to use this acl as the last one in a rule.
8251 Please note that the default ACL "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior
8252 declaration. This test was designed to be used with TCP request content
8253 inspection.
8254
8255 Examples :
8256 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
8257 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
8258 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
8259
8260 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
8261 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
8262 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
8263 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
8264 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
8265 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
8266 tcp-request content reject
8267
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008268
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020082697.5.3. Matching at Layer 7
8270--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008271
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008272A third set of criteria applies to information which can be found at the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008273application layer (layer 7). Those require that a full HTTP request has been
8274read, and are only evaluated then. They may require slightly more CPU resources
8275than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and response are indexed.
8276
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +02008277base <string>
8278 Returns true when the concatenation of the first Host header and the path
8279 part of the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the
8280 question mark, equals one of the strings. It may be used to match known
8281 files in virtual hosting environments, such as "www.example.com/favicon.ico".
8282 See also "path" and "uri".
8283
8284base_beg <string>
8285 Returns true when the base (see above) begins with one of the strings. This
8286 can be used to send certain directory names to alternative backends. See also
8287 "path_beg".
8288
8289base_dir <string>
8290 Returns true when one of the strings is found isolated or delimited with
8291 slashes in the base (see above). Probably of little use, see "url_dir" and
8292 "path_dir" instead.
8293
8294base_dom <string>
8295 Returns true when one of the strings is found isolated or delimited with dots
8296 in the base (see above). Probably of little use, see "path_dom" and "url_dom"
8297 instead.
8298
8299base_end <string>
8300 Returns true when the base (see above) ends with one of the strings. This may
8301 be used to control file name extension, though "path_end" is cheaper.
8302
8303base_len <integer>
8304 Returns true when the base (see above) length matches the values or ranges
8305 specified. This may be used to detect abusive requests for instance.
8306
8307base_reg <regex>
8308 Returns true when the base (see above) matches one of the regular
8309 expressions. It can be used any time, but it is important to remember that
8310 regex matching is slower than other methods. See also "path_reg", "url_reg"
8311 and all "base_" criteria.
8312
8313base_sub <string>
8314 Returns true when the base (see above) contains one of the strings. It can be
8315 used to detect particular patterns in paths, such as "../" for example. See
8316 also "base_dir".
8317
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +02008318cook(<name>) <string>
8319 All "cook*" matching criteria inspect all "Cookie" headers to find a cookie
8320 with the name between parenthesis. If multiple occurrences of the cookie are
8321 found in the request, they will all be evaluated. Spaces around the name and
8322 the value are ignored as requested by the Cookie specification (RFC6265). The
8323 cookie name is case-sensitive. Use the scook() variant for response cookies
8324 sent by the server.
8325
8326 The "cook" criteria returns true if any of the request cookies <name> match
8327 any of the strings. This can be used to check exact for values. For instance,
8328 checking that the "profile" cookie is set to either "silver" or "gold" :
8329
8330 cook(profile) silver gold
8331
8332cook_beg(<name>) <string>
8333 Returns true if any of the request cookies <name> begins with one of the
8334 strings. See "cook" for more information on cookie matching. Use the
8335 scook_beg() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
8336
8337cook_cnt(<name>) <integer>
8338 Returns true when the number of occurrences of the specified cookie matches
8339 the values or ranges specified. This is used to detect presence, absence or
8340 abuse of a specific cookie. See "cook" for more information on header
8341 matching. Use the scook_cnt() variant for response cookies sent by the
8342 server.
8343
8344cook_dir(<name>) <string>
8345 Returns true if any of the request cookies <name> contains one of the strings
8346 either isolated or delimited by slashes. This is used to perform filename or
8347 directory name matching, though it generally is of limited use with cookies.
8348 See "cook" for more information on cookie matching. Use the scook_dir()
8349 variant for response cookies sent by the server.
8350
8351cook_dom(<name>) <string>
8352 Returns true if any of the request cookies <name> contains one of the strings
8353 either isolated or delimited by dots. This is used to perform domain name
8354 matching. See "cook" for more information on cookie matching. Use the
8355 scook_dom() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
8356
8357cook_end(<name>) <string>
8358 Returns true if any of the request cookies <name> ends with one of the
8359 strings. See "cook" for more information on cookie matching. Use the
8360 scook_end() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
8361
8362cook_len(<name>) <integer>
8363 Returns true if any of the request cookies <name> has a length which matches
8364 the values or ranges specified. This may be used to detect empty or too large
8365 cookie values. Note that an absent cookie does not match a zero-length test.
8366 See "cook" for more information on cookie matching. Use the scook_len()
8367 variant for response cookies sent by the server.
8368
8369cook_reg(<name>) <regex>
8370 Returns true if any of the request cookies <name> matches any of the regular
8371 expressions. It can be used at any time, but it is important to remember that
8372 regex matching is slower than other methods. See also other "cook_" criteria,
8373 as well as "cook" for more information on cookie matching. Use the
8374 scook_reg() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
8375
8376cook_sub(<name>) <string>
8377 Returns true if any of the request cookies <name> contains at least one of
8378 the strings. See "cook" for more information on cookie matching. Use the
8379 scook_sub() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
8380
Willy Tarreau51539362012-05-08 12:46:28 +02008381cook_val(<name>) <integer>
8382 Returns true if any of the request cookies <name> starts with a number which
8383 matches the values or ranges specified. This may be used to select a server
8384 based on application-specific cookies. Note that an absent cookie does not
8385 match any value. See "cook" for more information on cookie matching. Use the
8386 scook_val() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
8387
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008388hdr <string>
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02008389hdr(<header>[,<occ>]) <string>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008390 Note: all the "hdr*" matching criteria either apply to all headers, or to a
8391 particular header whose name is passed between parenthesis and without any
8392 space. The header name is not case-sensitive. The header matching complies
8393 with RFC2616, and treats as separate headers all values delimited by commas.
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02008394 If an occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, only
8395 this occurrence will be considered. Positive values indicate a position from
8396 the first occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
8397 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. Use the shdr()
8398 variant for response headers sent by the server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008399
8400 The "hdr" criteria returns true if any of the headers matching the criteria
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +02008401 match any of the strings. This can be used to check for exact values. For
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008402 instance, checking that "connection: close" is set :
8403
8404 hdr(Connection) -i close
8405
8406hdr_beg <string>
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02008407hdr_beg(<header>[,<occ>]) <string>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008408 Returns true when one of the headers begins with one of the strings. See
8409 "hdr" for more information on header matching. Use the shdr_beg() variant for
8410 response headers sent by the server.
8411
8412hdr_cnt <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008413hdr_cnt(<header>) <integer>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008414 Returns true when the number of occurrence of the specified header matches
8415 the values or ranges specified. It is important to remember that one header
8416 line may count as several headers if it has several values. This is used to
8417 detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific header, as well as to block
8418 request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests which contain more than one
8419 of certain headers. See "hdr" for more information on header matching. Use
8420 the shdr_cnt() variant for response headers sent by the server.
8421
8422hdr_dir <string>
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02008423hdr_dir(<header>[,<occ>]) <string>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008424 Returns true when one of the headers contains one of the strings either
8425 isolated or delimited by slashes. This is used to perform filename or
8426 directory name matching, and may be used with Referer. See "hdr" for more
8427 information on header matching. Use the shdr_dir() variant for response
8428 headers sent by the server.
8429
8430hdr_dom <string>
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02008431hdr_dom(<header>[,<occ>]) <string>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008432 Returns true when one of the headers contains one of the strings either
8433 isolated or delimited by dots. This is used to perform domain name matching,
8434 and may be used with the Host header. See "hdr" for more information on
8435 header matching. Use the shdr_dom() variant for response headers sent by the
8436 server.
8437
8438hdr_end <string>
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02008439hdr_end(<header>[,<occ>]) <string>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008440 Returns true when one of the headers ends with one of the strings. See "hdr"
8441 for more information on header matching. Use the shdr_end() variant for
8442 response headers sent by the server.
8443
8444hdr_ip <ip_address>
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02008445hdr_ip(<header>[,<occ>]) <address>
8446 Returns true when one of the headers' values contains an IPv4 or IPv6 address
8447 matching <address>. This is mainly used with headers such as X-Forwarded-For
8448 or X-Client-IP. See "hdr" for more information on header matching. Use the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008449 shdr_ip() variant for response headers sent by the server.
8450
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +02008451hdr_len <integer>
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02008452hdr_len(<header>[,<occ>]) <integer>
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +02008453 Returns true when at least one of the headers has a length which matches the
8454 values or ranges specified. This may be used to detect empty or too large
8455 headers. See "hdr" for more information on header matching. Use the
8456 shdr_len() variant for response headers sent by the server.
8457
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008458hdr_reg <regex>
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02008459hdr_reg(<header>[,<occ>]) <regex>
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +02008460 Returns true it one of the headers matches one of the regular expressions. It
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008461 can be used at any time, but it is important to remember that regex matching
8462 is slower than other methods. See also other "hdr_" criteria, as well as
8463 "hdr" for more information on header matching. Use the shdr_reg() variant for
8464 response headers sent by the server.
8465
8466hdr_sub <string>
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02008467hdr_sub(<header>[,<occ>]) <string>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008468 Returns true when one of the headers contains one of the strings. See "hdr"
8469 for more information on header matching. Use the shdr_sub() variant for
8470 response headers sent by the server.
8471
8472hdr_val <integer>
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02008473hdr_val(<header>[,<occ>]) <integer>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008474 Returns true when one of the headers starts with a number which matches the
8475 values or ranges specified. This may be used to limit content-length to
8476 acceptable values for example. See "hdr" for more information on header
8477 matching. Use the shdr_val() variant for response headers sent by the server.
8478
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008479http_auth(<userlist>)
8480http_auth_group(<userlist>) <group> [<group>]*
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008481 Returns true when authentication data received from the client matches
8482 username & password stored on the userlist. It is also possible to
8483 use http_auth_group to check if the user is assigned to at least one
8484 of specified groups.
8485
8486 Currently only http basic auth is supported.
8487
Willy Tarreau85c27da2011-09-16 07:53:52 +02008488http_first_req
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +02008489 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
8490 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
8491 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or even to perform
8492 some specific ACL checks only on the first request.
8493
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008494method <string>
8495 Applies to the method in the HTTP request, eg: "GET". Some predefined ACL
8496 already check for most common methods.
8497
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008498path <string>
8499 Returns true when the path part of the request, which starts at the first
8500 slash and ends before the question mark, equals one of the strings. It may be
8501 used to match known files, such as /favicon.ico.
8502
8503path_beg <string>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008504 Returns true when the path begins with one of the strings. This can be used
8505 to send certain directory names to alternative backends.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008506
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008507path_dir <string>
8508 Returns true when one of the strings is found isolated or delimited with
8509 slashes in the path. This is used to perform filename or directory name
8510 matching without the risk of wrong match due to colliding prefixes. See also
8511 "url_dir" and "path_sub".
8512
8513path_dom <string>
8514 Returns true when one of the strings is found isolated or delimited with dots
8515 in the path. This may be used to perform domain name matching in proxy
8516 requests. See also "path_sub" and "url_dom".
8517
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008518path_end <string>
8519 Returns true when the path ends with one of the strings. This may be used to
8520 control file name extension.
8521
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +02008522path_len <integer>
8523 Returns true when the path length matches the values or ranges specified.
8524 This may be used to detect abusive requests for instance.
8525
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008526path_reg <regex>
8527 Returns true when the path matches one of the regular expressions. It can be
8528 used any time, but it is important to remember that regex matching is slower
8529 than other methods. See also "url_reg" and all "path_" criteria.
8530
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008531path_sub <string>
8532 Returns true when the path contains one of the strings. It can be used to
8533 detect particular patterns in paths, such as "../" for example. See also
8534 "path_dir".
8535
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +02008536payload(<offset>,<length>) <string>
8537 Returns true if the block of <length> bytes, starting at byte <offset> in the
8538 request or response buffer (depending on the rule) exactly matches one of the
8539 strings.
8540
8541payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>])
8542 Returns true if the block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
8543 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
8544 the request or response buffer (depending on the rule) exactly matches one of
8545 the strings. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
8546 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
8547
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008548req_ver <string>
8549 Applies to the version string in the HTTP request, eg: "1.0". Some predefined
8550 ACL already check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
8551
8552status <integer>
8553 Applies to the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, eg: "302". It can be
8554 used to act on responses depending on status ranges, for instance, remove
8555 any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
8556
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008557url <string>
8558 Applies to the whole URL passed in the request. The only real use is to match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +02008559 "*", for which there already is a predefined ACL. See also "base".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008560
8561url_beg <string>
8562 Returns true when the URL begins with one of the strings. This can be used to
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +02008563 check whether a URL begins with a slash or with a protocol scheme. See also
8564 "base_beg".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008565
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008566url_dir <string>
8567 Returns true when one of the strings is found isolated or delimited with
8568 slashes in the URL. This is used to perform filename or directory name
8569 matching without the risk of wrong match due to colliding prefixes. See also
8570 "path_dir" and "url_sub".
8571
8572url_dom <string>
8573 Returns true when one of the strings is found isolated or delimited with dots
8574 in the URL. This is used to perform domain name matching without the risk of
8575 wrong match due to colliding prefixes. See also "url_sub".
8576
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008577url_end <string>
8578 Returns true when the URL ends with one of the strings. It has very limited
8579 use. "path_end" should be used instead for filename matching.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008580
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02008581url_ip <address>
8582 Applies to the IPv4 or IPv6 address specified in the absolute URI in an HTTP
8583 request. It can be used to prevent access to certain resources such as local
8584 network. It is useful with option "http_proxy".
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +01008585
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +02008586url_len <integer>
8587 Returns true when the url length matches the values or ranges specified. This
8588 may be used to detect abusive requests for instance.
8589
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +01008590url_port <integer>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008591 Applies to the port specified in the absolute URI in an HTTP request. It can
8592 be used to prevent access to certain resources. It is useful with option
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01008593 "http_proxy". Note that if the port is not specified in the request, port 80
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008594 is assumed.
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +01008595
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008596url_reg <regex>
8597 Returns true when the URL matches one of the regular expressions. It can be
8598 used any time, but it is important to remember that regex matching is slower
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +02008599 than other methods. See also "base_reg", "path_reg" and all "url_" criteria.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01008600
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008601url_sub <string>
8602 Returns true when the URL contains one of the strings. It can be used to
8603 detect particular patterns in query strings for example. See also "path_sub".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01008604
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +02008605urlp(<name>) <string>
8606 Note: all "urlp*" matching criteria apply to the first occurrence of the
8607 parameter <name> in the query string. The parameter name is case-sensitive.
8608
8609 The "urlp" matching criteria returns true if the designated URL parameter
8610 matches any of the strings. This can be used to check for exact values.
8611
8612urlp_beg(<name>) <string>
8613 Returns true when the URL parameter "<name>" begins with one of the strings.
8614 This can be used to check whether a URL begins with a slash or with a
8615 protocol scheme.
8616
8617urlp_dir(<name>) <string>
8618 Returns true when the URL parameter "<name>" contains one of the strings
8619 either isolated or delimited with slashes. This is used to perform filename
8620 or directory name matching in a specific URL parameter without the risk of
8621 wrong match due to colliding prefixes. See also "path_dir" and "urlp_sub".
8622
8623urlp_dom(<name>) <string>
8624 Returns true when one of the strings is found isolated or delimited with dots
8625 in the URL parameter "<name>". This is used to perform domain name matching
8626 in a specific URL parameter without the risk of wrong match due to colliding
8627 prefixes. See also "urlp_sub".
8628
8629urlp_end(<name>) <string>
8630 Returns true when the URL parameter "<name>" ends with one of the strings.
8631
8632urlp_ip(<name>) <ip_address>
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02008633 Returns true when the URL parameter "<name>" contains an IPv4 or IPv6 address
8634 which matches one of the specified addresses.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +02008635
8636urlp_len(<name>) <integer>
8637 Returns true when the URL parameter "<name>" has a length matching the values
8638 or ranges specified. This is used to detect abusive requests for instance.
8639
8640urlp_reg(<name>) <regex>
8641 Returns true when the URL parameter "<name>" matches one of the regular
8642 expressions. It can be used any time, but it is important to remember that
8643 regex matching is slower than other methods. See also "path_reg" and all
8644 "urlp_" criteria.
8645
8646urlp_sub(<name>) <string>
8647 Returns true when the URL parameter "<name>" contains one of the strings. It
8648 can be used to detect particular patterns in query strings for example. See
8649 also "path_sub" and other "urlp_" criteria.
8650
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +02008651urlp_val(<name>) <integer>
8652 Returns true when the URL parameter "<name>" starts with a number matching
8653 the values or ranges specified. Note that the absence of the parameter does
8654 not match anything. Integers are unsigned so it is not possible to match
8655 negative data.
8656
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01008657
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020086587.6. Pre-defined ACLs
8659---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008660
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008661Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
8662every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +02008663order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008664
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008665ACL name Equivalent to Usage
8666---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008667FALSE always_false never match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +02008668HTTP req_proto_http match if protocol is valid HTTP
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008669HTTP_1.0 req_ver 1.0 match HTTP version 1.0
8670HTTP_1.1 req_ver 1.1 match HTTP version 1.1
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008671HTTP_CONTENT hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length
8672HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
8673HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
8674HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
8675LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008676METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
8677METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
8678METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
8679METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
8680METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
8681METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +02008682RDP_COOKIE req_rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008683REQ_CONTENT req_len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008684TRUE always_true always match
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008685WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
8686---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008687
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008688
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020086897.7. Using ACLs to form conditions
8690----------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008691
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008692Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
8693combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008694
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008695 - AND (implicit)
8696 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
8697 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008698
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008699A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008700
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008701 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008702
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008703Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
8704indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008705
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008706For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
8707"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
8708requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
8709is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008710
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008711 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
8712 block if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
8713 block if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
8714 block unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008715
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008716To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
8717and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008718
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008719 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
8720 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
8721 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
8722 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008723
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008724 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static urls
8725 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
8726 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
8727 use_backend www if host_www
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008728
Willy Tarreau95fa4692010-02-01 13:05:50 +01008729It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
8730expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
8731be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008732the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
Willy Tarreau95fa4692010-02-01 13:05:50 +01008733
8734 The following rule :
8735
8736 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
8737 block if METH_POST missing_cl
8738
8739 Can also be written that way :
8740
8741 block if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
8742
8743It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
8744to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
8745simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
8746sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
8747good use is the following :
8748
8749 With named ACLs :
8750
8751 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
8752 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
8753 monitor fail if site_dead
8754
8755 With anonymous ACLs :
8756
8757 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
8758
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008759See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "block" and "use_backend" keywords.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008760
Willy Tarreau5764b382007-11-30 17:46:49 +01008761
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010087627.8. Pattern extraction
8763-----------------------
8764
8765The stickiness features relies on pattern extraction in the request and
8766response. Sometimes the data needs to be converted first before being stored,
8767for instance converted from ASCII to IP or upper case to lower case.
8768
8769All these operations of data extraction and conversion are defined as
8770"pattern extraction rules". A pattern rule always has the same format. It
8771begins with a single pattern fetch word, potentially followed by a list of
8772arguments within parenthesis then an optional list of transformations. As
8773much as possible, the pattern fetch functions use the same name as their
8774equivalent used in ACLs.
8775
8776The list of currently supported pattern fetch functions is the following :
8777
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +02008778 base This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the
8779 path part of the request, which starts at the first slash and
8780 ends before the question mark. It can be useful in virtual
8781 hosted environments to detect URL abuses as well as to improve
8782 shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size stick
8783 table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
8784 requested objects by host/path.
Emeric Brunb4354082012-09-28 17:28:03 +02008785 client_crt
8786 Returns 1 if a client certificate is present in an incoming
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +02008787 connection over SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise 0.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +02008788
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008789 src This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session.
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01008790 It is of type IPv4 and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
8791 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent,
8792 according to RFC 4291.
8793
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008794 dst This is the destination IPv4 address of the session on the
8795 client side, which is the address the client connected to.
8796 It can be useful when running in transparent mode. It is of
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01008797 type IPv4 and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
8798 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent,
8799 according to RFC 4291.
8800
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008801 dst_port This is the destination TCP port of the session on the client
8802 side, which is the port the client connected to. This might be
8803 used when running in transparent mode or when assigning dynamic
8804 ports to some clients for a whole application session. It is of
8805 type integer and only works with such tables.
8806
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02008807 hdr(<name>[,<occ>])
8808 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP
8809 request. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as
8810 a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
8811 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
8812 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the
8813 last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header once
Willy Tarreaue428fb72011-12-16 21:50:30 +01008814 converted to IP, associated with an IP stick-table.
Willy Tarreau4a568972010-05-12 08:08:50 +02008815
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +02008816 is_ssl This checks the transport layer used by incoming connection, and
8817 returns 1 if the connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
8818 layer, otherwise zero.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02008819
Willy Tarreau6812bcf2012-04-29 09:28:50 +02008820 path This extracts the request's URL path (without the host part). A
8821 typical use is with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals
8822 which need to aggregate multiple information from databases and
8823 keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing caches, it would be
8824 wiser to use "url" instead.
8825
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008826 payload(<offset>,<length>)
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008827 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes, and starting
8828 at bytes <offset> in the buffer of request or response (request
8829 on "stick on" or "stick match" or response in on "stick store
8830 response").
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008831
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008832 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>])
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008833 This extracts a binary block. In a first step the size of the
8834 block is read from response or request buffer at <offset>
8835 bytes and considered coded on <length> bytes. In a second step
8836 data of the block are read from buffer at <offset2> bytes
8837 (by default <lengthoffset> + <lengthsize>).
8838 If <offset2> is prefixed by '+' or '-', it is relative to
8839 <lengthoffset> + <lengthsize> else it is absolute.
8840 Ex: see SSL session id example in "stick table" chapter.
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008841
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +02008842 src_port This is the source TCP port of the session on the client side,
8843 which is the port the client connected from. It is very unlikely
8844 that this function will be useful but it's available at no cost.
8845 It is of type integer and only works with such tables.
8846
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +02008847 ssl_has_sni This checks the transport layer used by incoming connection, and
8848 returns 1 if the connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
8849 layer and the client sent a Server Name Indication TLS extension,
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02008850 otherwise zero. This requires that the SSL library is build with
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +02008851 support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02008852
8853 ssl_sni This extracts the Server Name Indication field from an incoming
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +02008854 connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
8855 deciphered by haproxy. The result typically is a string matching
8856 the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must
8857 have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
8858 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02008859
Emeric Brun3603fbe2012-09-28 18:35:15 +02008860 ssl_verify_caerr
8861 Returns the ID of the first error detected during verify at
8862 depth > 0 or 0 if no errors.
8863
8864 ssl_verify_caerr_depth
8865 Returns the depth of the first error detected during verify.
8866
8867 ssl_verify_crterr
8868 Returns the ID of the first error detected during verify at
8869 depth == 0 or 0 if no errors.
8870
Emeric Brunc68af8d2012-09-28 18:14:24 +02008871 ssl_verify_result
8872 Returns the verify result errorID when the incoming connection
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +02008873 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunc68af8d2012-09-28 18:14:24 +02008874
Willy Tarreau6812bcf2012-04-29 09:28:50 +02008875 url This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A
8876 typical use is with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals
8877 which need to aggregate multiple information from databases and
8878 keep them in caches. See also "path".
8879
8880 url_ip This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the
8881 host part is presented as an IP address. Its use is very
8882 limited. For instance, a monitoring system might use this field
8883 as an alternative for the source IP in order to test what path a
8884 given source address would follow, or to force an entry in a
8885 table for a given source address.
8886
8887 url_port This extracts the port part from the request's URL. It probably
8888 is totally useless but it was available at no cost.
8889
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008890 url_param(<name>)
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02008891 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in
8892 the query string of the request and uses the corresponding value
8893 to match. A typical use is to get sticky session through url
8894 (e.g. http://example.com/foo?JESSIONID=some_id with
8895 url_param(JSESSIONID)), for cases where cookies cannot be used.
David Cournapeau16023ee2010-12-23 20:55:41 +09008896
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008897 rdp_cookie(<name>)
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02008898 This extracts the value of the rdp cookie <name> as a string
8899 and uses this value to match. This enables implementation of
8900 persistence based on the mstshash cookie. This is typically
8901 done if there is no msts cookie present.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09008902
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02008903 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing
8904 algorithm may be used and thus the distribution of clients
8905 to backend servers is not linked to a hash of the RDP
8906 cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
8907 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconnect" will
8908 lead to a more even distribution of clients to backend
8909 servers than the hash used by "balance rdp-cookie".
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09008910
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02008911 Example :
8912 listen tse-farm
8913 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
8914 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
8915 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
8916 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
8917 # apply RDP cookie persistence
8918 persist rdp-cookie
8919 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
8920 # This is only useful makes sense if
8921 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
8922 stick-table type string size 204800
8923 stick on rdp_cookie(mstshash)
8924 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
8925 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09008926
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02008927 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie",
8928 "tcp-request" and the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09008929
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008930 cookie(<name>)
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02008931 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a
Willy Tarreau28376d62012-04-26 21:26:10 +02008932 "Cookie" header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header
8933 from the response, and uses the corresponding value to match. A
8934 typical use is to get multiple clients sharing a same profile
8935 use the same server. This can be similar to what "appsession"
8936 does with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
8937 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Willy Tarreaub3eb2212011-07-01 16:16:17 +02008938
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02008939 See also : "appsession"
Willy Tarreaub3eb2212011-07-01 16:16:17 +02008940
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008941 set-cookie(<name>)
Willy Tarreau28376d62012-04-26 21:26:10 +02008942 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the
8943 "cookie" fetch which is capable of handling both requests and
8944 responses. This keyword will disappear soon.
8945
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02008946 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a
8947 "Set-Cookie" header line from the response and uses the
8948 corresponding value to match. This can be comparable to what
8949 "appsession" does with default options, but with support for
8950 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Willy Tarreaub3eb2212011-07-01 16:16:17 +02008951
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02008952 See also : "appsession"
Willy Tarreaub3eb2212011-07-01 16:16:17 +02008953
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09008954
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008955The currently available list of transformations include :
8956
8957 lower Convert a string pattern to lower case. This can only be placed
8958 after a string pattern fetch function or after a conversion
8959 function returning a string type. The result is of type string.
8960
8961 upper Convert a string pattern to upper case. This can only be placed
8962 after a string pattern fetch function or after a conversion
8963 function returning a string type. The result is of type string.
8964
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008965 ipmask(<mask>) Apply a mask to an IPv4 address, and use the result for lookups
Willy Tarreaud31d6eb2010-01-26 18:01:41 +01008966 and storage. This can be used to make all hosts within a
8967 certain mask to share the same table entries and as such use
8968 the same server. The mask can be passed in dotted form (eg:
8969 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (eg: 24).
8970
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008971
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020089728. Logging
8973----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008974
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008975One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
8976provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
8977very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
8978provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
8979state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008980to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008981headers.
8982
8983In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
8984about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
8985send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
8986
8987 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
8988 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
8989 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
8990 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
8991 at the termination.
8992
8993The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
8994allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
8995as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
8996while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
8997real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
8998delay.
8999
9000
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020090018.1. Log levels
9002---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009003
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +09009004TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009005source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +09009006HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
9007in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
9008track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
9009syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
9010about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009011
9012
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020090138.2. Log formats
9014----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009015
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01009016HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +09009017and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
9018slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
9019options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009020
9021 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
9022 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
9023 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
9024 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
9025 extents.
9026
9027 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
9028 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
9029 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
9030 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
9031 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
9032
9033 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
9034 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
9035 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
9036 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
9037 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
9038
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02009039 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
9040 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
9041 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
9042 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
9043
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01009044 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
9045
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009046Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
9047specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
9048field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
9049servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
9050always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
9051identifier.
9052
9053Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
9054 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
9055 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
9056 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
9057 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
9058
9059
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020090608.2.1. Default log format
9061-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009062
9063This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
9064as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
9065format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
9066
9067 Example :
9068 listen www
9069 mode http
9070 log global
9071 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
9072
9073 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
9074 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
9075 (www/HTTP)
9076
9077 Field Format Extract from the example above
9078 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
9079 2 'Connect from' Connect from
9080 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
9081 4 'to' to
9082 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
9083 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
9084
9085Detailed fields description :
9086 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
9087 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
9088 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
9089 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
9090 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
9091 and processed the connection.
9092 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
9093
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01009094In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
9095"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
9096connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
9097
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009098It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
9099will eventually disappear.
9100
9101
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020091028.2.2. TCP log format
9103---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009104
9105The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
9106is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
9107information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
9108counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
9109emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
9110environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
9111the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
9112sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02009113specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
9114not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
9115fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
9116marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009117
9118 Example :
9119 frontend fnt
9120 mode tcp
9121 option tcplog
9122 log global
9123 default_backend bck
9124
9125 backend bck
9126 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
9127
9128 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
9129 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
9130 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
9131
9132 Field Format Extract from the example above
9133 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
9134 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
9135 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
9136 4 frontend_name fnt
9137 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
9138 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
9139 7 bytes_read* 212
9140 8 termination_state --
9141 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
9142 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
9143
9144Detailed fields description :
9145 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01009146 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
9147 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
9148 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
9149 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, then the logs will reflect the
9150 forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009151
9152 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01009153 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
9154 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
9155 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009156
9157 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
9158 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
9159 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
9160 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log.
9161
9162 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
9163 and processed the connection.
9164
9165 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
9166 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
9167 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
9168 applications.
9169
9170 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
9171 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
9172 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
9173 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
9174 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
9175
9176 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
9177 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
9178 See "Timers" below for more details.
9179
9180 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
9181 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
9182 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
9183 "Timers" below for more details.
9184
9185 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
9186 last close. It covers all possible processings. There is one exception, if
9187 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
9188 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
9189 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
9190 details.
9191
9192 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
9193 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
9194 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
9195 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
9196 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
9197
9198 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
9199 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
9200 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
9201 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
9202 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
9203 for more details.
9204
9205 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009206 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009207 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
9208 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
9209 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009210 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009211
9212 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
9213 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
9214 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
9215 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
9216 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
9217 caused by a denial of service attack.
9218
9219 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
9220 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
9221 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
9222 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
9223 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
9224 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
9225 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
9226 denial of service attack.
9227
9228 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
9229 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
9230 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
9231 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
9232 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
9233 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
9234 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
9235 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
9236 be processed than on other servers.
9237
9238 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
9239 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
9240 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
9241 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
9242 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
9243 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
9244 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
9245 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
9246 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
9247 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
9248 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
9249 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
9250 should not be attributed to the logged server.
9251
9252 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
9253 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
9254 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
9255 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
9256 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
9257 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
9258 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
9259 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
9260
9261 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
9262 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
9263 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
9264 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
9265 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
9266 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
9267 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
9268 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
9269 occurs.
9270
9271
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020092728.2.3. HTTP log format
9273----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009274
9275The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
9276is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
9277the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
9278are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
9279emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
9280generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
9281"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
9282which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02009283frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
9284is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009285
9286Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
9287slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
9288with a star ('*') after the field name below.
9289
9290 Example :
9291 frontend http-in
9292 mode http
9293 option httplog
9294 log global
9295 default_backend bck
9296
9297 backend static
9298 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
9299
9300 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
9301 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
9302 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009303 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009304
9305 Field Format Extract from the example above
9306 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
9307 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
9308 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
9309 4 frontend_name http-in
9310 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
9311 6 Tq '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Tt* 10/0/30/69/109
9312 7 status_code 200
9313 8 bytes_read* 2750
9314 9 captured_request_cookie -
9315 10 captured_response_cookie -
9316 11 termination_state ----
9317 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
9318 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
9319 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
9320 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
9321 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009322
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009323
9324Detailed fields description :
9325 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01009326 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
9327 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
9328 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
9329 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, then the logs will reflect the
9330 forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009331
9332 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01009333 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
9334 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
9335 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009336
9337 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the TCP connection was received by
9338 haproxy (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on
9339 the network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is
9340 usually the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. This
9341 does not depend on the fact that the client has sent the request or not.
9342
9343 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
9344 and processed the connection.
9345
9346 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
9347 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
9348 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
9349
9350 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
9351 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
9352 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
9353 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
9354 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
9355 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
9356
9357 - "Tq" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the client to send
9358 a full HTTP request, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the connection
9359 was aborted before a complete request could be received. It should always
9360 be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet. Large
9361 times here generally indicate network trouble between the client and
9362 haproxy. See "Timers" below for more details.
9363
9364 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
9365 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
9366 See "Timers" below for more details.
9367
9368 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
9369 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
9370 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See "Timers"
9371 below for more details.
9372
9373 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
9374 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
9375 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
9376 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
9377 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
9378 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See "Timers" below
9379 for more details.
9380
9381 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
9382 last close. It covers all possible processings. There is one exception, if
9383 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
9384 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
9385 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
9386 details.
9387
9388 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
9389 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
9390 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
9391
9392 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
9393 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
9394 specified, the this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
9395 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
9396 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
9397 overflowing.
9398
9399 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
9400 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
9401 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
9402 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
9403 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
9404 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
9405 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
9406 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
9407
9408 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
9409 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
9410 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
9411 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
9412 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
9413 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
9414 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
9415 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
9416
9417 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
9418 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
9419 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
9420 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
9421 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
9422 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
9423 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
9424
9425 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009426 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009427 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
9428 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
9429 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009430 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009431 system.
9432
9433 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
9434 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
9435 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
9436 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
9437 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
9438 caused by a denial of service attack.
9439
9440 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
9441 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
9442 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
9443 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
9444 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
9445 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
9446 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
9447 denial of service attack.
9448
9449 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
9450 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
9451 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
9452 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
9453 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
9454 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
9455 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
9456 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
9457 processed than on other servers.
9458
9459 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
9460 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
9461 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
9462 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
9463 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
9464 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
9465 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
9466 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
9467 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
9468 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
9469 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
9470 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
9471 should not be attributed to the logged server.
9472
9473 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
9474 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
9475 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
9476 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
9477 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
9478 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
9479 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
9480 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
9481
9482 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
9483 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
9484 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
9485 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
9486 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
9487 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
9488 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
9489 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
9490 occurs.
9491
9492 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
9493 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
9494 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
9495 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
9496 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
9497 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
9498 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
9499 cookies" below for more details.
9500
9501 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
9502 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
9503 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
9504 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
9505 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
9506 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
9507 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
9508 and cookies" below for more details.
9509
9510 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
9511 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
9512 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
9513 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
9514 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
9515 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
9516 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
9517 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
9518
9519
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020095208.2.4. Custom log format
9521------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01009522
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +01009523The directive log-format allows you to custom the logs in http mode and tcp
9524mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01009525
9526HAproxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
9527Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
9528separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
9529prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
9530
9531Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
9532variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
9533string formats ("Q").
9534
9535Note: spaces must be escaped. A space character is considered as a separator.
9536HAproxy will automatically merge consecutive separators.
9537
9538Flags are :
9539 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009540 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01009541
9542 Example:
9543
9544 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
9545 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
9546
9547At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
9548
9549 log-format %Ci:%Cp\ [%t]\ %f\ %b/%s\ %Tq/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Tt\ %st\ %B\ %cc\ \
Willy Tarreau6580c062012-03-12 15:09:42 +01009550 %cs\ %tsc\ %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc\ %sq/%bq\ %hr\ %hs\ %{+Q}r
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01009551
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +01009552the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01009553
9554 log-format %{+Q}o\ %{-Q}Ci\ -\ -\ [%T]\ %r\ %st\ %B\ \"\"\ \"\"\ %Cp\ \
Willy Tarreau6580c062012-03-12 15:09:42 +01009555 %ms\ %f\ %b\ %s\ \%Tq\ %Tw\ %Tc\ %Tr\ %Tt\ %tsc\ %ac\ %fc\ \
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01009556 %bc\ %sc\ %rc\ %sq\ %bq\ %cc\ %cs\ \%hrl\ %hsl
9557
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +01009558and the default TCP format is defined this way :
9559
9560 log-format %Ci:%Cp\ [%t]\ %f\ %b/%s\ %Tw/%Tc/%Tt\ %B\ %ts\ \
9561 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc\ %sq/%bq
9562
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01009563Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
9564
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +01009565 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
9566 | H | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
9567 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
9568 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
9569 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
9570 | | %B | bytes_read | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +02009571 | | %Ci | client_ip | IP |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +01009572 | | %Cp | client_port | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +02009573 | | %Bi | backend_source_ip | IP |
William Lallemandb7ff6a32012-03-02 14:35:21 +01009574 | | %Bp | backend_source_port | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +02009575 | | %Fi | frontend_ip | IP |
9576 | | %Fp | frontend_port | numeric |
9577 | | %H | hostname | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01009578 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +02009579 | | %Si | server_IP | IP |
9580 | | %Sp | server_port | numeric |
9581 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +01009582 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
9583 | * | %Tq | Tq | numeric |
9584 | * | %Tr | Tr | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +02009585 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +01009586 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
9587 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
9588 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
9589 | | %b | backend_name | string |
9590 | | %bc | beconn | numeric |
9591 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
9592 | * | %cc | captured_request_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +02009593 | * | %rt | http_request_counter | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +01009594 | * | %cs | captured_response_cookie | string |
9595 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
9596 | | %fc | feconn | numeric |
9597 | * | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
9598 | * | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
9599 | * | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
9600 | * | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
9601 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +02009602 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +01009603 | * | %r | http_request | string |
9604 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
9605 | | %s | server_name | string |
9606 | | %sc | srv_conn | numeric |
9607 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
9608 | * | %st | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +02009609 | | %t | date_time | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +01009610 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreau6580c062012-03-12 15:09:42 +01009611 | * | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +01009612 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01009613
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +02009614*: mode http only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01009615
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020096168.3. Advanced logging options
9617-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009618
9619Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
9620just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
9621options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
9622for more information about their usage.
9623
9624
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020096258.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
9626------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009627
9628It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
9629haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
9630commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
9631monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
9632ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
9633
9634 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
9635 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
9636 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
9637 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
9638
9639 - if the connection come from a known source network, use "monitor-net" to
9640 declare this network as monitoring only. Any host in this network will then
9641 only be able to perform health checks, and their requests will not be
9642 logged. This is generally appropriate to designate a list of equipments
9643 such as other load-balancers.
9644
9645 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
9646 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
9647 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
9648
9649
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020096508.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
9651----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009652
9653The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
9654what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
9655or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
9656"option logasap" in the frontend. Haproxy will then log as soon as possible,
9657just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
9658log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
9659after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
9660is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
9661with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
9662with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
9663
9664
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020096658.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
9666------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02009667
9668Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
9669for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
9670"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
9671retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
9672raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
9673a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
9674file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
9675you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
9676"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
9677
9678
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020096798.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
9680--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02009681
9682Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
9683multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
9684them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
9685"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
9686logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
9687error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
9688and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
9689too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
9690useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
9691alternative.
9692
9693
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020096948.4. Timing events
9695------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009696
9697Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
9698reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
9699the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
9700frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
9701mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "Tq/Tw/Tc/Tr/Tt" :
9702
9703 - Tq: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
9704 elapsed between the moment the client connection was accepted and the
9705 moment the proxy received the last HTTP header. The value "-1" indicates
9706 that the end of headers (empty line) has never been seen. This happens when
9707 the client closes prematurely or times out.
9708
9709 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
9710 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
9711 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
9712 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
9713 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
9714
9715 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
9716 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
9717 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
9718 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
9719 connection never established.
9720
9721 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
9722 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
9723 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
9724 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
9725 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
9726 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
9727 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
9728 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
9729 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
9730 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
9731 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
9732
9733 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
9734 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
9735 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Tq+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is
9736 prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
9737 transmission time, by substracting other timers when valid :
9738
9739 Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr)
9740
9741 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
9742 mode, "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never be
9743 negative.
9744
9745These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
9746protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
9747that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009748due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Tt" is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009749close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means that a
9750session has been aborted on timeout.
9751
9752Most common cases :
9753
9754 - If "Tq" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
9755 client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might happen
9756 when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It may
9757 happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network cause.
9758 Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has ended,
9759 haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds. The time
9760 spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay processing
9761 of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the order of
9762 a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of new
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +02009763 connections have been accepted at once. Setting "option http-server-close"
9764 may display larger request times since "Tq" also measures the time spent
9765 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009766
9767 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
9768 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
9769 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
9770 of ms on remote networks.
9771
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009772 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
9773 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
9774 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009775
9776 - If "Tt" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
9777 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection, for
9778 instance because both have agreed on a keep-alive connection mode. In order
9779 to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify "option httpclose" on
9780 either the frontend or the backend. If the problem persists, it means that
9781 the server ignores the "close" connection mode and expects the client to
9782 close. Then it will be required to use "option forceclose". Having the
9783 smallest possible 'Tt' is important when connection regulation is used with
9784 the "maxconn" option on the servers, since no new connection will be sent
9785 to the server until another one is released.
9786
9787Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
9788
9789 Tq/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Tt The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
9790 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
9791 except "Tt" which is shorter than reality.
9792
9793 -1/xx/xx/xx/Tt The client was not able to send a complete request in time
9794 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
9795 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
9796
9797 Tq/-1/xx/xx/Tt It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
9798 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
9799 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
9800 flags.
9801
9802 Tq/Tw/-1/xx/Tt The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
9803 actively refused it or it timed out after Tt-(Tq+Tw) ms.
9804 Check the session termination flags, then check the
9805 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
9806 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
9807 the client connection was maintained open.
9808
9809 Tq/Tw/Tc/-1/Tt The server has accepted the connection but did not return
9810 a complete response in time, or it closed its connexion
9811 unexpectedly after Tt-(Tq+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
9812 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
9813
9814
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020098158.5. Session state at disconnection
9816-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009817
9818TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
9819"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
98202-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
9821each of which has a special meaning :
9822
9823 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
9824 session to terminate :
9825
9826 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
9827
9828 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
9829 server explicitly refused it.
9830
9831 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
9832 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
9833 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
9834 error in server response which might have caused information leak
9835 (eg: cacheable cookie), or because the response was processed by
9836 the proxy (redirect, stats, etc...).
9837
9838 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
9839 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
9840 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
9841 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
9842 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
9843
9844 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
9845 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
9846 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
9847 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
9848 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
9849
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +09009850 D : the session was killed by haproxy because the server was detected
9851 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
9852
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -07009853 U : the session was killed by haproxy on this backup server because an
9854 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
9855 backup connections when going up.
9856
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +02009857 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on haproxy.
9858
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009859 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
9860 send or receive data.
9861
9862 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
9863 send or receive data.
9864
9865 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
9866 with nothing left in the buffers.
9867
9868 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
9869
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01009870 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009871 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
9872
9873 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
9874 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
9875 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
9876 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
9877 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
9878
9879 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
9880 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
9881
9882 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
9883 server (HTTP only).
9884
9885 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
9886
9887 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
9888 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
9889 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
9890
9891 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
9892 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
9893 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
9894
9895 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
9896
9897 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
9898 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
9899
9900 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
9901 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
9902 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
9903
9904 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
9905 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02009906 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
9907 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009908
9909 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
9910 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
9911 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
9912 another server.
9913
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02009914 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009915 server.
9916
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02009917 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
9918 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
9919 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
9920 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
9921
9922 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
9923 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
9924 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
9925 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
9926
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +02009927 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
9928 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
9929 "use-server" rule).
9930
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009931 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
9932
9933 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
9934 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
9935
9936 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
9937
9938 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
9939 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
9940 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
9941
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02009942 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
9943 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
9944 happens everytime there is activity at a different date than the
9945 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
9946 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
9947
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009948 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
9949
9950 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
9951 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
9952
9953 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
9954
9955 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
9956
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02009957The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
9958was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009959helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
9960starvation, attacks, etc...
9961
9962The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
9963alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
9964easier finding and understanding.
9965
9966 Flags Reason
9967
9968 -- Normal termination.
9969
9970 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
9971 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
9972 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
9973 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
9974
9975 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
9976 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
9977 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
9978 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
9979 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
9980 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009981
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009982 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
9983 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009984 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009985
9986 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
9987 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
9988 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
9989
9990 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
9991 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
9992 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
9993 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
9994 the server takes too long to respond.
9995
9996 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
9997 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
9998 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
9999 long a time to respond.
10000
10001 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
10002 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
10003 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
10004 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
10005 and the client.
10006
10007 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
10008 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
10009 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
10010 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
10011 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
10012 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here.
10013
10014 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
10015 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010016 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
10017 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
10018 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
10019 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010020
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010021 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010022 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
10023 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
10024 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (eg: no route,
10025 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
10026 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
10027
10028 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
10029 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
10030 503 or 504 here.
10031
10032 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
10033 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
10034 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
10035 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
10036 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
10037
10038 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
10039 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010040 by too short timeouts on L4 equipments before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010041 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
10042 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
10043
10044 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
10045 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
10046 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
10047 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
10048 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
10049 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
10050 between haproxy and the server.
10051
10052 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
10053 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
10054 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
10055 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
10056 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
10057 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
10058 solution is to fix the application.
10059
10060 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
10061 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
10062 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
10063 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
10064 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
10065 external attacks.
10066
10067 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
10068 process' socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020010069 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010070 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
10071 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
10072
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010010073 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
10074 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
10075 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
10076 the client.
10077
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010078 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
10079 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
10080 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
10081 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010010082 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
10083 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
10084 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
10085 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
10086 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010087
10088 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
10089 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
10090 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
10091 returned an HTTP 403 error.
10092
10093 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
10094 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
10095 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
10096 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
10097
10098 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
10099 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
10100 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
10101 only be solved by proper system tuning.
10102
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020010103The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
10104persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
10105important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
10106re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
10107
10108 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
10109
10110 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
10111 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
10112 set on a GET request.
10113
10114 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
10115 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010116 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020010117 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
10118
10119 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
10120 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
10121 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
10122
10123 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
10124 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
10125 already got a cookie.
10126
10127 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
10128 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
10129 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
10130 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
10131 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
10132
10133 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
10134 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
10135 new cookie was inserted in the response.
10136
10137 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
10138 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
10139 new cookie was inserted in the response.
10140
10141 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
10142 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
10143
10144 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
10145 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
10146 then advertised in the response.
10147
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010148
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200101498.6. Non-printable characters
10150-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010151
10152In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
10153consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
10154converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
10155prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
10156being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
10157escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
10158is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
10159'}' when logging headers.
10160
10161Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
10162issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
10163containing spaces is "User-Agent".
10164
10165Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
10166the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
10167performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
10168
10169
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200101708.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
10171---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010172
10173Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
10174achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010175section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010176cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
10177the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
10178the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010179locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010180not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
10181user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
10182a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
10183wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
10184
10185 Examples :
10186 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
10187 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
10188
10189 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
10190 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
10191
10192
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200101938.8. Capturing HTTP headers
10194---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010195
10196Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
10197proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
10198the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
10199server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
10200
10201Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
10202response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010203section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010204
10205It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010206time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
10207appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010208are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
10209and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
10210follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
10211request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
10212in the logs.
10213
10214 Example :
10215 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
10216 listen proxy-out
10217 mode http
10218 option httplog
10219 option logasap
10220 log global
10221 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
10222
10223 # log the name of the virtual server
10224 capture request header Host len 20
10225
10226 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
10227 capture request header Content-Length len 10
10228
10229 # log the beginning of the referrer
10230 capture request header Referer len 20
10231
10232 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
10233 capture response header Server len 20
10234
10235 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
10236 capture response header Content-Length len 10
10237
10238 # log the expected cache behaviour on the response
10239 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
10240
10241 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
10242 capture response header Via len 20
10243
10244 # log the URL location during a redirection
10245 capture response header Location len 20
10246
10247 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
10248 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
10249 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
10250 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
10251 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
10252
10253 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
10254 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
10255 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
10256 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010257 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010258
10259 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
10260 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
10261 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
10262 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
10263 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010264 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010265
10266
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200102678.9. Examples of logs
10268---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010269
10270These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
10271them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
10272reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
10273
10274 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
10275 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
10276 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
10277
10278 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
10279 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
10280
10281 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
10282 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
10283 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
10284
10285 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
10286 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
10287
10288 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
10289 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
10290 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
10291
10292 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010293 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010294 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
10295 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
10296
10297 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
10298 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
10299 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
10300
10301 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "rspdeny" or
10302 "rspideny" filter, or because the response was improperly formatted and
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +020010303 not HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010304 risked being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502
10305 bad gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided
10306 to return the 502 and not the server.
10307
10308 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010309 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010310
10311 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
10312 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
10313 Nothing was sent to any server.
10314
10315 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
10316 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
10317
10318 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
10319 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
10320 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
10321 send a 408 return code to the client.
10322
10323 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
10324 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
10325
10326 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
10327 5 seconds ("c----").
10328
10329 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
10330 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010331 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010332
10333 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010334 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010335 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
10336 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
10337 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
10338 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
10339 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010340
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010010341
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200103429. Statistics and monitoring
10343----------------------------
10344
10345It is possible to query HAProxy about its status. The most commonly used
10346mechanism is the HTTP statistics page. This page also exposes an alternative
10347CSV output format for monitoring tools. The same format is provided on the
10348Unix socket.
10349
10350
103519.1. CSV format
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010010352---------------
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010010353
Willy Tarreau7f062c42009-03-05 18:43:00 +010010354The statistics may be consulted either from the unix socket or from the HTTP
10355page. Both means provide a CSV format whose fields follow.
10356
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010010357 0. pxname: proxy name
10358 1. svname: service name (FRONTEND for frontend, BACKEND for backend, any name
10359 for server)
10360 2. qcur: current queued requests
10361 3. qmax: max queued requests
10362 4. scur: current sessions
10363 5. smax: max sessions
10364 6. slim: sessions limit
10365 7. stot: total sessions
10366 8. bin: bytes in
10367 9. bout: bytes out
10368 10. dreq: denied requests
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010010369 11. dresp: denied responses
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010010370 12. ereq: request errors
10371 13. econ: connection errors
Willy Tarreauae526782010-03-04 20:34:23 +010010372 14. eresp: response errors (among which srv_abrt)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010010373 15. wretr: retries (warning)
10374 16. wredis: redispatches (warning)
Cyril Bonté0dae5852010-02-03 00:26:28 +010010375 17. status: status (UP/DOWN/NOLB/MAINT/MAINT(via)...)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010010376 18. weight: server weight (server), total weight (backend)
10377 19. act: server is active (server), number of active servers (backend)
10378 20. bck: server is backup (server), number of backup servers (backend)
10379 21. chkfail: number of failed checks
10380 22. chkdown: number of UP->DOWN transitions
10381 23. lastchg: last status change (in seconds)
10382 24. downtime: total downtime (in seconds)
10383 25. qlimit: queue limit
10384 26. pid: process id (0 for first instance, 1 for second, ...)
10385 27. iid: unique proxy id
10386 28. sid: service id (unique inside a proxy)
10387 29. throttle: warm up status
10388 30. lbtot: total number of times a server was selected
10389 31. tracked: id of proxy/server if tracking is enabled
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +020010390 32. type (0=frontend, 1=backend, 2=server, 3=socket)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkidb57c6b2009-08-31 21:23:27 +020010391 33. rate: number of sessions per second over last elapsed second
10392 34. rate_lim: limit on new sessions per second
10393 35. rate_max: max number of new sessions per second
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki09605412009-09-23 22:09:24 +020010394 36. check_status: status of last health check, one of:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010010395 UNK -> unknown
10396 INI -> initializing
10397 SOCKERR -> socket error
10398 L4OK -> check passed on layer 4, no upper layers testing enabled
10399 L4TMOUT -> layer 1-4 timeout
10400 L4CON -> layer 1-4 connection problem, for example
10401 "Connection refused" (tcp rst) or "No route to host" (icmp)
10402 L6OK -> check passed on layer 6
10403 L6TOUT -> layer 6 (SSL) timeout
10404 L6RSP -> layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
10405 L7OK -> check passed on layer 7
10406 L7OKC -> check conditionally passed on layer 7, for example 404 with
10407 disable-on-404
10408 L7TOUT -> layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
10409 L7RSP -> layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
10410 L7STS -> layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki09605412009-09-23 22:09:24 +020010411 37. check_code: layer5-7 code, if available
10412 38. check_duration: time in ms took to finish last health check
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010413 39. hrsp_1xx: http responses with 1xx code
10414 40. hrsp_2xx: http responses with 2xx code
10415 41. hrsp_3xx: http responses with 3xx code
10416 42. hrsp_4xx: http responses with 4xx code
10417 43. hrsp_5xx: http responses with 5xx code
10418 44. hrsp_other: http responses with other codes (protocol error)
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010419 45. hanafail: failed health checks details
10420 46. req_rate: HTTP requests per second over last elapsed second
10421 47. req_rate_max: max number of HTTP requests per second observed
10422 48. req_tot: total number of HTTP requests received
Willy Tarreauae526782010-03-04 20:34:23 +010010423 49. cli_abrt: number of data transfers aborted by the client
10424 50. srv_abrt: number of data transfers aborted by the server (inc. in eresp)
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010425
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010010426
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200104279.2. Unix Socket commands
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010010428-------------------------
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010010429
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010010430The following commands are supported on the UNIX stats socket ; all of them
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020010431must be terminated by a line feed. The socket supports pipelining, so that it
10432is possible to chain multiple commands at once provided they are delimited by
10433a semi-colon or a line feed, although the former is more reliable as it has no
10434risk of being truncated over the network. The responses themselves will each be
10435followed by an empty line, so it will be easy for an external script to match a
10436given response with a given request. By default one command line is processed
10437then the connection closes, but there is an interactive allowing multiple lines
10438to be issued one at a time.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010010439
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020010440It is important to understand that when multiple haproxy processes are started
10441on the same sockets, any process may pick up the request and will output its
10442own stats.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010010443
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010444clear counters
10445 Clear the max values of the statistics counters in each proxy (frontend &
10446 backend) and in each server. The cumulated counters are not affected. This
10447 can be used to get clean counters after an incident, without having to
10448 restart nor to clear traffic counters. This command is restricted and can
10449 only be issued on sockets configured for levels "operator" or "admin".
10450
10451clear counters all
10452 Clear all statistics counters in each proxy (frontend & backend) and in each
10453 server. This has the same effect as restarting. This command is restricted
10454 and can only be issued on sockets configured for level "admin".
10455
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090010456clear table <table> [ data.<type> <operator> <value> ] | [ key <key> ]
10457 Remove entries from the stick-table <table>.
10458
10459 This is typically used to unblock some users complaining they have been
10460 abusively denied access to a service, but this can also be used to clear some
10461 stickiness entries matching a server that is going to be replaced (see "show
10462 table" below for details). Note that sometimes, removal of an entry will be
10463 refused because it is currently tracked by a session. Retrying a few seconds
10464 later after the session ends is usual enough.
10465
10466 In the case where no options arguments are given all entries will be removed.
10467
10468 When the "data." form is used entries matching a filter applied using the
10469 stored data (see "stick-table" in section 4.2) are removed. A stored data
10470 type must be specified in <type>, and this data type must be stored in the
10471 table otherwise an error is reported. The data is compared according to
10472 <operator> with the 64-bit integer <value>. Operators are the same as with
10473 the ACLs :
10474
10475 - eq : match entries whose data is equal to this value
10476 - ne : match entries whose data is not equal to this value
10477 - le : match entries whose data is less than or equal to this value
10478 - ge : match entries whose data is greater than or equal to this value
10479 - lt : match entries whose data is less than this value
10480 - gt : match entries whose data is greater than this value
10481
10482 When the key form is used the entry <key> is removed. The key must be of the
Simon Horman619e3cc2011-06-15 15:18:52 +090010483 same type as the table, which currently is limited to IPv4, IPv6, integer and
10484 string.
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020010485
10486 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020010487 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020010488 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020010489 >>> 0x80e6a4c: key=127.0.0.1 use=0 exp=3594729 gpc0=0 conn_rate(30000)=1 \
10490 bytes_out_rate(60000)=187
10491 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
10492 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020010493
10494 $ echo "clear table http_proxy key 127.0.0.1" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
10495
10496 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020010497 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:1
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020010498 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
10499 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090010500 $ echo "clear table http_proxy data.gpc0 eq 1" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
10501 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
10502 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:1
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020010503
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020010504disable frontend <frontend>
10505 Mark the frontend as temporarily stopped. This corresponds to the mode which
10506 is used during a soft restart : the frontend releases the port but can be
10507 enabled again if needed. This should be used with care as some non-Linux OSes
10508 are unable to enable it back. This is intended to be used in environments
10509 where stopping a proxy is not even imaginable but a misconfigured proxy must
10510 be fixed. That way it's possible to release the port and bind it into another
10511 process to restore operations. The frontend will appear with status "STOP"
10512 on the stats page.
10513
10514 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
10515 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
10516
10517 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
10518 level "admin".
10519
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010520disable server <backend>/<server>
10521 Mark the server DOWN for maintenance. In this mode, no more checks will be
10522 performed on the server until it leaves maintenance.
10523 If the server is tracked by other servers, those servers will be set to DOWN
10524 during the maintenance.
10525
10526 In the statistics page, a server DOWN for maintenance will appear with a
10527 "MAINT" status, its tracking servers with the "MAINT(via)" one.
10528
10529 Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020010530 their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010531
10532 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
10533 level "admin".
10534
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020010535enable frontend <frontend>
10536 Resume a frontend which was temporarily stopped. It is possible that some of
10537 the listening ports won't be able to bind anymore (eg: if another process
10538 took them since the 'disable frontend' operation). If this happens, an error
10539 is displayed. Some operating systems might not be able to resume a frontend
10540 which was disabled.
10541
10542 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
10543 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
10544
10545 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
10546 level "admin".
10547
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010548enable server <backend>/<server>
10549 If the server was previously marked as DOWN for maintenance, this marks the
10550 server UP and checks are re-enabled.
10551
10552 Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020010553 their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010554
10555 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
10556 level "admin".
10557
10558get weight <backend>/<server>
10559 Report the current weight and the initial weight of server <server> in
10560 backend <backend> or an error if either doesn't exist. The initial weight is
10561 the one that appears in the configuration file. Both are normally equal
10562 unless the current weight has been changed. Both the backend and the server
10563 may be specified either by their name or by their numeric ID, prefixed with a
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020010564 sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010565
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020010566help
10567 Print the list of known keywords and their basic usage. The same help screen
10568 is also displayed for unknown commands.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010010569
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020010570prompt
10571 Toggle the prompt at the beginning of the line and enter or leave interactive
10572 mode. In interactive mode, the connection is not closed after a command
10573 completes. Instead, the prompt will appear again, indicating the user that
10574 the interpreter is waiting for a new command. The prompt consists in a right
10575 angle bracket followed by a space "> ". This mode is particularly convenient
10576 when one wants to periodically check information such as stats or errors.
10577 It is also a good idea to enter interactive mode before issuing a "help"
10578 command.
10579
10580quit
10581 Close the connection when in interactive mode.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010010582
Willy Tarreau2a0f4d22011-08-02 11:49:05 +020010583set maxconn frontend <frontend> <value>
Willy Tarreau3c7a79d2012-09-26 21:07:15 +020010584 Dynamically change the specified frontend's maxconn setting. Any positive
10585 value is allowed including zero, but setting values larger than the global
10586 maxconn does not make much sense. If the limit is increased and connections
10587 were pending, they will immediately be accepted. If it is lowered to a value
10588 below the current number of connections, new connections acceptation will be
Willy Tarreau2a0f4d22011-08-02 11:49:05 +020010589 delayed until the threshold is reached. The frontend might be specified by
10590 either its name or its numeric ID prefixed with a sharp ('#').
10591
Willy Tarreau91886b62011-09-07 14:38:31 +020010592set maxconn global <maxconn>
10593 Dynamically change the global maxconn setting within the range defined by the
10594 initial global maxconn setting. If it is increased and connections were
10595 pending, they will immediately be accepted. If it is lowered to a value below
10596 the current number of connections, new connections acceptation will be
10597 delayed until the threshold is reached. A value of zero restores the initial
10598 setting.
10599
Willy Tarreauf5b22872011-09-07 16:13:44 +020010600set rate-limit connections global <value>
10601 Change the process-wide connection rate limit, which is set by the global
10602 'maxconnrate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. This limit
10603 applies to all frontends and the change has an immediate effect. The value
10604 is passed in number of connections per second.
10605
Willy Tarreau654694e2012-06-07 01:03:16 +020010606set table <table> key <key> data.<data_type> <value>
10607 Create or update a stick-table entry in the table. If the key is not present,
10608 an entry is inserted. See stick-table in section 4.2 to find all possible
10609 values for <data_type>. The most likely use consists in dynamically entering
10610 entries for source IP addresses, with a flag in gpc0 to dynamically block an
10611 IP address or affect its quality of service.
10612
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010613set timeout cli <delay>
10614 Change the CLI interface timeout for current connection. This can be useful
10615 during long debugging sessions where the user needs to constantly inspect
10616 some indicators without being disconnected. The delay is passed in seconds.
10617
10618set weight <backend>/<server> <weight>[%]
10619 Change a server's weight to the value passed in argument. If the value ends
10620 with the '%' sign, then the new weight will be relative to the initially
10621 configured weight. Relative weights are only permitted between 0 and 100%,
10622 and absolute weights are permitted between 0 and 256. Servers which are part
10623 of a farm running a static load-balancing algorithm have stricter limitations
10624 because the weight cannot change once set. Thus for these servers, the only
10625 accepted values are 0 and 100% (or 0 and the initial weight). Changes take
10626 effect immediately, though certain LB algorithms require a certain amount of
10627 requests to consider changes. A typical usage of this command is to disable
10628 a server during an update by setting its weight to zero, then to enable it
10629 again after the update by setting it back to 100%. This command is restricted
10630 and can only be issued on sockets configured for level "admin". Both the
10631 backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by their
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020010632 numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010633
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010010634show errors [<iid>]
10635 Dump last known request and response errors collected by frontends and
10636 backends. If <iid> is specified, the limit the dump to errors concerning
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +020010637 either frontend or backend whose ID is <iid>. This command is restricted
10638 and can only be issued on sockets configured for levels "operator" or
10639 "admin".
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010010640
10641 The errors which may be collected are the last request and response errors
10642 caused by protocol violations, often due to invalid characters in header
10643 names. The report precisely indicates what exact character violated the
10644 protocol. Other important information such as the exact date the error was
10645 detected, frontend and backend names, the server name (when known), the
10646 internal session ID and the source address which has initiated the session
10647 are reported too.
10648
10649 All characters are returned, and non-printable characters are encoded. The
10650 most common ones (\t = 9, \n = 10, \r = 13 and \e = 27) are encoded as one
10651 letter following a backslash. The backslash itself is encoded as '\\' to
10652 avoid confusion. Other non-printable characters are encoded '\xNN' where
10653 NN is the two-digits hexadecimal representation of the character's ASCII
10654 code.
10655
10656 Lines are prefixed with the position of their first character, starting at 0
10657 for the beginning of the buffer. At most one input line is printed per line,
10658 and large lines will be broken into multiple consecutive output lines so that
10659 the output never goes beyond 79 characters wide. It is easy to detect if a
10660 line was broken, because it will not end with '\n' and the next line's offset
10661 will be followed by a '+' sign, indicating it is a continuation of previous
10662 line.
10663
10664 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020010665 $ echo "show errors" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
10666 >>> [04/Mar/2009:15:46:56.081] backend http-in (#2) : invalid response
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010010667 src 127.0.0.1, session #54, frontend fe-eth0 (#1), server s2 (#1)
10668 response length 213 bytes, error at position 23:
10669
10670 00000 HTTP/1.0 200 OK\r\n
10671 00017 header/bizarre:blah\r\n
10672 00038 Location: blah\r\n
10673 00054 Long-line: this is a very long line which should b
10674 00104+ e broken into multiple lines on the output buffer,
10675 00154+ otherwise it would be too large to print in a ter
10676 00204+ minal\r\n
10677 00211 \r\n
10678
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010679 In the example above, we see that the backend "http-in" which has internal
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010010680 ID 2 has blocked an invalid response from its server s2 which has internal
10681 ID 1. The request was on session 54 initiated by source 127.0.0.1 and
10682 received by frontend fe-eth0 whose ID is 1. The total response length was
10683 213 bytes when the error was detected, and the error was at byte 23. This
10684 is the slash ('/') in header name "header/bizarre", which is not a valid
10685 HTTP character for a header name.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010010686
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020010687show info
10688 Dump info about haproxy status on current process.
10689
10690show sess
10691 Dump all known sessions. Avoid doing this on slow connections as this can
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +020010692 be huge. This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets
10693 configured for levels "operator" or "admin".
10694
Willy Tarreau66dc20a2010-03-05 17:53:32 +010010695show sess <id>
10696 Display a lot of internal information about the specified session identifier.
10697 This identifier is the first field at the beginning of the lines in the dumps
10698 of "show sess" (it corresponds to the session pointer). Those information are
10699 useless to most users but may be used by haproxy developers to troubleshoot a
10700 complex bug. The output format is intentionally not documented so that it can
10701 freely evolve depending on demands.
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020010702
10703show stat [<iid> <type> <sid>]
10704 Dump statistics in the CSV format. By passing <id>, <type> and <sid>, it is
10705 possible to dump only selected items :
10706 - <iid> is a proxy ID, -1 to dump everything
10707 - <type> selects the type of dumpable objects : 1 for frontends, 2 for
10708 backends, 4 for servers, -1 for everything. These values can be ORed,
10709 for example:
10710 1 + 2 = 3 -> frontend + backend.
10711 1 + 2 + 4 = 7 -> frontend + backend + server.
10712 - <sid> is a server ID, -1 to dump everything from the selected proxy.
10713
10714 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020010715 $ echo "show info;show stat" | socat stdio unix-connect:/tmp/sock1
10716 >>> Name: HAProxy
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020010717 Version: 1.4-dev2-49
10718 Release_date: 2009/09/23
10719 Nbproc: 1
10720 Process_num: 1
10721 (...)
10722
10723 # pxname,svname,qcur,qmax,scur,smax,slim,stot,bin,bout,dreq, (...)
10724 stats,FRONTEND,,,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,0,,,,,OPEN,,,,,,,,,1,1,0, (...)
10725 stats,BACKEND,0,0,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,,0,0,0,0,UP,0,0,0,,0,250,(...)
10726 (...)
10727 www1,BACKEND,0,0,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,,0,0,0,0,UP,1,1,0,,0,250, (...)
10728
10729 $
10730
10731 Here, two commands have been issued at once. That way it's easy to find
10732 which process the stats apply to in multi-process mode. Notice the empty
10733 line after the information output which marks the end of the first block.
10734 A similar empty line appears at the end of the second block (stats) so that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010735 the reader knows the output has not been truncated.
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020010736
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020010737show table
10738 Dump general information on all known stick-tables. Their name is returned
10739 (the name of the proxy which holds them), their type (currently zero, always
10740 IP), their size in maximum possible number of entries, and the number of
10741 entries currently in use.
10742
10743 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020010744 $ echo "show table" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090010745 >>> # table: front_pub, type: ip, size:204800, used:171454
10746 >>> # table: back_rdp, type: ip, size:204800, used:0
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020010747
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090010748show table <name> [ data.<type> <operator> <value> ] | [ key <key> ]
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020010749 Dump contents of stick-table <name>. In this mode, a first line of generic
10750 information about the table is reported as with "show table", then all
10751 entries are dumped. Since this can be quite heavy, it is possible to specify
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090010752 a filter in order to specify what entries to display.
10753
10754 When the "data." form is used the filter applies to the stored data (see
10755 "stick-table" in section 4.2). A stored data type must be specified
10756 in <type>, and this data type must be stored in the table otherwise an
10757 error is reported. The data is compared according to <operator> with the
10758 64-bit integer <value>. Operators are the same as with the ACLs :
10759
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020010760 - eq : match entries whose data is equal to this value
10761 - ne : match entries whose data is not equal to this value
10762 - le : match entries whose data is less than or equal to this value
10763 - ge : match entries whose data is greater than or equal to this value
10764 - lt : match entries whose data is less than this value
10765 - gt : match entries whose data is greater than this value
10766
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090010767
10768 When the key form is used the entry <key> is shown. The key must be of the
Simon Horman619e3cc2011-06-15 15:18:52 +090010769 same type as the table, which currently is limited to IPv4, IPv6, integer,
10770 and string.
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090010771
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020010772 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020010773 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090010774 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020010775 >>> 0x80e6a4c: key=127.0.0.1 use=0 exp=3594729 gpc0=0 conn_rate(30000)=1 \
10776 bytes_out_rate(60000)=187
10777 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
10778 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020010779
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020010780 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.gpc0 gt 0" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090010781 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020010782 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
10783 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020010784
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020010785 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.conn_rate gt 5" | \
10786 socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090010787 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020010788 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
10789 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020010790
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090010791 $ echo "show table http_proxy key 127.0.0.2" | \
10792 socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090010793 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090010794 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
10795 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
10796
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020010797 When the data criterion applies to a dynamic value dependent on time such as
10798 a bytes rate, the value is dynamically computed during the evaluation of the
10799 entry in order to decide whether it has to be dumped or not. This means that
10800 such a filter could match for some time then not match anymore because as
10801 time goes, the average event rate drops.
10802
10803 It is possible to use this to extract lists of IP addresses abusing the
10804 service, in order to monitor them or even blacklist them in a firewall.
10805 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020010806 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.gpc0 gt 0" \
10807 | socat stdio /tmp/sock1 \
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020010808 | fgrep 'key=' | cut -d' ' -f2 | cut -d= -f2 > abusers-ip.txt
10809 ( or | awk '/key/{ print a[split($2,a,"=")]; }' )
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki719e7262009-10-04 15:02:46 +020010810
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020010811shutdown frontend <frontend>
10812 Completely delete the specified frontend. All the ports it was bound to will
10813 be released. It will not be possible to enable the frontend anymore after
10814 this operation. This is intended to be used in environments where stopping a
10815 proxy is not even imaginable but a misconfigured proxy must be fixed. That
10816 way it's possible to release the port and bind it into another process to
10817 restore operations. The frontend will not appear at all on the stats page
10818 once it is terminated.
10819
10820 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
10821 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
10822
10823 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
10824 level "admin".
10825
Willy Tarreaua295edc2011-09-07 23:21:03 +020010826shutdown session <id>
10827 Immediately terminate the session matching the specified session identifier.
10828 This identifier is the first field at the beginning of the lines in the dumps
10829 of "show sess" (it corresponds to the session pointer). This can be used to
10830 terminate a long-running session without waiting for a timeout or when an
10831 endless transfer is ongoing. Such terminated sessions are reported with a 'K'
10832 flag in the logs.
10833
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020010834shutdown sessions <backend>/<server>
10835 Immediately terminate all the sessions attached to the specified server. This
10836 can be used to terminate long-running sessions after a server is put into
10837 maintenance mode, for instance. Such terminated sessions are reported with a
10838 'K' flag in the logs.
10839
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010840/*
10841 * Local variables:
10842 * fill-column: 79
10843 * End:
10844 */